blob: f8766f6ba7bfe01a095db8d5b46b851691c4c56c [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau396d2002020-04-02 09:02:11 +02007 2020/04/02
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
676. HTTP header manipulation
68
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
707.1. ACL basics
717.1.1. Matching booleans
727.1.2. Matching integers
737.1.3. Matching strings
747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
787.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200797.3.1. Converters
807.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086
878. Logging
888.1. Log levels
898.2. Log formats
908.2.1. Default log format
918.2.2. TCP log format
928.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100938.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100948.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200958.3. Advanced logging options
968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1008.4. Timing events
1018.5. Session state at disconnection
1028.6. Non-printable characters
1038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1058.9. Examples of logs
106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001079. Supported filters
1089.1. Trace
1099.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001109.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001119.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200112
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011310. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011410.1. Limitation
11510.2. Setup
11610.2.1. Cache section
11710.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118
1191. Quick reminder about HTTP
120----------------------------
121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
124on almost anything found in the contents.
125
126However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
127formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
128correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
129
130
1311.1. The HTTP transaction model
132-------------------------------
133
134The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100135to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
137connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138will involve a new connection :
139
140 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
141
142In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
143establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
144by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
145length.
146
147Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
148to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
149however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
150response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
151header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
156power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
157but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100160Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
162second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
163page :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
168latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
169correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
170the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100171server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
174time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
175are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
176parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
177carry the stream identifier.
178
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100179By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
180connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
181leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
183processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
184waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200185
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200186HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
188 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100189 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200191 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100193For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
194the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
196is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
197servers.
198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199
2001.2. HTTP request
201-----------------
202
203First, let's consider this HTTP request :
204
205 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100206 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
208 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
209 3 User-agent: my small browser
210 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
211 5 Accept: image/png
212
213
2141.2.1. The Request line
215-----------------------
216
217Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
218
219 - a METHOD : GET
220 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
222
223All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
224which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
225followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
226is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
227desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
228the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
229
230The URI itself can have several forms :
231
232 - A "relative URI" :
233
234 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235
236 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
237 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
238
239 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
240
241 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
244 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
245 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
246 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
247 must accept this form too.
248
249 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
250 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
251 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200253 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
254 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
255 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
256 other protocols too.
257
258In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
259mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
260on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
261It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
262specific to the language, framework or application in use.
263
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100264HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100265assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100266However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
267received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
268processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
269as well as in server logs.
270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271
2721.2.2. The request headers
273--------------------------
274
275The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
276beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
277an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
278Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
279values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
280encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
281the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
282define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
283
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100284Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
287as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288
289The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
290that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
291is one valid form of empty line.
292
293Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
294headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
295about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
296application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
297
298Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000299 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
301 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
302 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
303
304
3051.3. HTTP response
306------------------
307
308An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
309messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
310
311 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
314 2 Content-length: 350
315 3 Content-Type: text/html
316
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200317As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
318codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
319response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100320continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
321the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
322following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
323sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
324(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
325correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
326such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
327state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
328over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
329if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
330information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334------------------------
335
336Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
337
338 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
339 - a status code : 200
340 - a reason : OK
341
342The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100343 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
344 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
345 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
346 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
347 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200348
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000349Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100350"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
352messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
353or "Authentication Required".
354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
357 Code When / reason
358 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
359 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
361 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100362 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
363 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364 400 for an invalid or too large request
365 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
366 accessing the stats page)
367 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
368 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
369 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
370 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
371 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
372 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
373 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
374 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
375 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
376
377The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3784.2).
379
380
3811.3.2. The response headers
382---------------------------
383
384Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
385the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
386details.
387
388
3892. Configuring HAProxy
390----------------------
391
3922.1. Configuration file format
393------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200394
395HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
396
397 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
398 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
399 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
400 "frontend" and "backend".
401
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100402The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
403referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200404delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200406
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004072.2. Quoting and escaping
408-------------------------
409
410HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
411many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
412with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
413single quotes.
414
415If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
416them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
417escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
418
419Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
420
421 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
422 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
423 \\ to use a backslash
424 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
425 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
426
427Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
428the interpretation of:
429
430 space as a parameter separator
431 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
432 # hash as a comment start
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200434Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
435-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
436backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
437
438Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200439quoting.
440
441Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
442nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
443
444Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
445equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
446
447 Example:
448 # those are equivalents:
449 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
451 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
453 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
454
455 # those are equivalents:
456 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
459 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
460
461
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004622.3. Environment variables
463--------------------------
464
465HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
466interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
467configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
468optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
469shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
470underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
471
472 Example:
473
474 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
475
476 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
477
478 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
479
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200480Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
481file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200482
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200483* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
484 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
485
486* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
487 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
488 directory.
489
490* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
491
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500492* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493 processes, separated by semicolons.
494
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500495* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496 CLI, separated by semicolons.
497
498See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200499
5002.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200501----------------
502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100503Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100504values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
505otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
506numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
507for every keyword. Supported units are :
508
509 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
510 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
511 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
512 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
513 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
514 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
515
516
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005172.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200518-------------
519
520 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
521 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
522 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
523 global
524 daemon
525 maxconn 256
526
527 defaults
528 mode http
529 timeout connect 5000ms
530 timeout client 50000ms
531 timeout server 50000ms
532
533 frontend http-in
534 bind *:80
535 default_backend servers
536
537 backend servers
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
542 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
543 global
544 daemon
545 maxconn 256
546
547 defaults
548 mode http
549 timeout connect 5000ms
550 timeout client 50000ms
551 timeout server 50000ms
552
553 listen http-in
554 bind *:80
555 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
556
557
558Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
559
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100560 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200561
562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005633. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564--------------------
565
566Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
567are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
568of them have command-line equivalents.
569
570The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
571
572 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200573 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200575 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200578 - description
579 - deviceatlas-json-file
580 - deviceatlas-log-level
581 - deviceatlas-separator
582 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900583 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - gid
585 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100586 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200587 - h1-case-adjust
588 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100591 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200593 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200595 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200596 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100598 - presetenv
599 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600 - uid
601 - ulimit-n
602 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200603 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100604 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200605 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200607 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - ssl-default-bind-options
609 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200610 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200611 - ssl-default-server-options
612 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100613 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100614 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100616 - 51degrees-data-file
617 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200618 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200619 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200620 - wurfl-data-file
621 - wurfl-information-list
622 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200623 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100624
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200625 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200626 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200628 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100629 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100630 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100631 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200632 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200633 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200634 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200635 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636 - noepoll
637 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000638 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200639 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100640 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300641 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000642 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100643 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200644 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200645 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200646 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000647 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000648 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200649 - tune.buffers.limit
650 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200651 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200652 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100653 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200654 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200655 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200656 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100657 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200658 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200659 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100660 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100661 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100662 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100663 - tune.lua.session-timeout
664 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200665 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100666 - tune.maxaccept
667 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200668 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200669 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200670 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100671 - tune.rcvbuf.client
672 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100673 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200674 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100675 - tune.sndbuf.client
676 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100677 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100678 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200679 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100680 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200681 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200682 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100683 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200684 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100685 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200686 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
687 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
688 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100689 - tune.zlib.memlevel
690 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100691
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200692 * Debugging
693 - debug
694 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200695
696
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006973.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200698------------------------------------
699
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200700ca-base <dir>
701 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200702 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
703 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200704
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200705chroot <jail dir>
706 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
707 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
708 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
709 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
710 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100711 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100712
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100713cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
714 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
715 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
716 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
717 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
718 set. These sets have the format
719
720 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
721
722 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100723 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100724 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
725 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100726 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
727 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100728 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100729 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100731 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100732 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
733 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
734 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
735 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100736
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100737 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
738 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
739 on the machine's word size.
740
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
743 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
744 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
745 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
746 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
747 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100748
749 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
751
752 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
753 # first 4 CPUs
754
755 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
756 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
757 # word size.
758
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100759 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100761 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
762 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
763 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
764
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100765 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
766 # and so on.
767 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
768 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
769 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100771 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100772 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
773 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
774 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
775
776 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
777 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
778 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
779
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100780 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
781 # and a thread range.
782 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
783 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
784 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
785
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200786crt-base <dir>
787 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
788 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
789 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
790
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200791daemon
792 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
793 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100794 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
795 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200796
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200797deviceatlas-json-file <path>
798 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100799 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200800
801deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100802 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200803 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
804
805deviceatlas-separator <char>
806 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
807 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
808
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100809deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200810 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
811 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
812 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100813
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900814external-check
815 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
816 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
817 See "option external-check".
818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819gid <number>
820 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
821 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
822 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100823 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
824 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200825 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100826
Willy Tarreau8b852462019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100827group <group name>
828 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
829 See also "gid" and "user".
830
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100831hard-stop-after <time>
832 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
833
834 Arguments :
835 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
836 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
837 SIGUSR1 signal.
838
839 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
840 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
841 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
842
843 Example:
844 global
845 hard-stop-after 30s
846
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200847h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
848 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
849 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
850 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
851 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin5c836fd2020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500852 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200853 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
854 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
855 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
856 specified in a proxy.
857
858 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
859 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
860 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
861 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
862 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
863 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
864 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
865
866 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
867 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
868 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
869 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
870 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
871
872 Example:
873 global
874 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
875
876 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
877 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
878
879h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
880 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
881 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
882 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
883 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
884 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
885 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
886 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
887 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
888
889 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
890 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
891 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
892
893 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
894 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
895
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200896log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
897 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100898 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100899 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100900 configured with "log global".
901
902 <address> can be one of:
903
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100904 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100905 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
906 port).
907
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100908 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
909 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
910 port).
911
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100912 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100913 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
914 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100915 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100916
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100917 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
918 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
919 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
920 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
921 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
922 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
923 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
924 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
925 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
926 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
927 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
928 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
929 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
930 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100931 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
932 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100933
934 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
935 "fd@2", see above.
936
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200937 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
938 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100939
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200940 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
941 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
942 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
943 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
944 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
945 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
946 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
947 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
948 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
949 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100950 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
951 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200952
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200953 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
954 one of the following :
955
956 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
957 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
958
959 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
960 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
961
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100962 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
963 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
964 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
965 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
966 logger consumes.
967
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100968 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
969 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
970 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
971 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
972
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200973 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
974 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
975 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
976 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
977 set with <sample_size> parameter.
978
979 <sample_size>
980 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
981 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
982 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
983 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
984 (see also <ranges> parameter).
985
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100986 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200987
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100988 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
989 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
990 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
991
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100992 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
993 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
994 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
995 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200996
997 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200998 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
999 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1000 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1001 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1002 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1003 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001004
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001005 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001007log-send-hostname [<string>]
1008 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1009 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1010 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1011 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1012 the logs.
1013
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001014log-tag <string>
1015 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1016 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1017 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001018 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001019
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001020lua-load <file>
1021 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1022 used multiple times.
1023
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001024master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001025 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1026 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1027 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001028 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001029 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1030 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001031 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1032 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1033 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1034 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1035 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001036
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001037 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001038
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001039mworker-max-reloads <number>
1040 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001041 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001042 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1043 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1044 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1045
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001046nbproc <number>
1047 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1048 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1049 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001050 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1051 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001052 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1053 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001054
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001055nbthread <number>
1056 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001057 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1058 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1059 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1060 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1061 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001062 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1063 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1064 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1065 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1066 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1067 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1068 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001069
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001070pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001071 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001072 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1073 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1074
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001075presetenv <name> <value>
1076 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1077 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1078 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1079 and "unsetenv".
1080
1081resetenv [<name> ...]
1082 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1083 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1084 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1085 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1086 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1087 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1088 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1089 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1090
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001091stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001092 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1093 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1094 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1095 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1096 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1097 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001098 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001099 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1100 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1101 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1102 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001103
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001104server-state-base <directory>
1105 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001106 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1107 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001108
1109server-state-file <file>
1110 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1111 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1112 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1113 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1114 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1115 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1116 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1117 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001118 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1119 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001120
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001121setenv <name> <value>
1122 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1123 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1124 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1125 and "unsetenv".
1126
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001127set-dumpable
1128 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1129 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1130 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1131 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1132 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1133 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1134 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1135 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1136 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1137 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1138 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1139 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1140 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1141 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1142 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1143 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1144 expected when dying.
1145
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001146ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1147 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1148 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001149 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001150 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001151 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1152 information and recommendations see e.g.
1153 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1154 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1155 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1156 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001157
1158ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1159 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1160 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1161 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1162 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1163 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001164 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1165 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1166 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001167 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001168
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001169ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1170 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1171 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1172 keyword to see available options.
1173
1174 Example:
1175 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001176 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001177
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001178ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1179 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1180 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001181 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001182 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001183 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1184 information and recommendations see e.g.
1185 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1186 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1187 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1188 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1189 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001190
1191ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1192 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1193 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1194 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1195 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1196 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001197 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1198 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1199 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1200 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001201
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001202ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1203 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1204 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1205 keyword to see available options.
1206
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001207ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1208 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1209 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1210 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001211 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001212 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001213 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1214 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1215 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1216 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001217 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1218 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1219 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1220
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001221ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1222 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1223 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1224 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1225
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001226stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1227 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1228 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1229 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001230 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001231 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001232
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001233 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1234 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1235 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001236
1237stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1238 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1239 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001240 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001241
1242stats maxconn <connections>
1243 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1244 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1245
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001246uid <number>
1247 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1248 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1249 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1250 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1251
1252ulimit-n <number>
1253 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1254 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1255 option.
1256
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001257unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1258 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1259
1260 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1261 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1262 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1263 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1264 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1265 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1266 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1267 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1268 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1269 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1270
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001271unsetenv [<name> ...]
1272 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1273 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1274 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1275 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1276 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1277 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1278 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1279
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001280user <user name>
1281 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1282 See also "uid" and "group".
1283
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001284node <name>
1285 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1286
1287 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1288 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1289 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1290 traffic.
1291
1292description <text>
1293 Add a text that describes the instance.
1294
1295 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1296 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1297 "<" and ">" characters.
1298
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100129951degrees-data-file <file path>
1300 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001301 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001302
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001303 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001304 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1305
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000130651degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001307 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1308 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1309 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1310
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001311 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001312 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1313
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200131451degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001315 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1316 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1317
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001318 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1319 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1320
132151degrees-cache-size <number>
1322 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1323 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1324 By default, this cache is disabled.
1325
1326 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001327 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1328
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001329wurfl-data-file <file path>
1330 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1331 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1332
1333 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1334 with USE_WURFL=1.
1335
1336wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1337 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1338 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1339 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1340
1341 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1342
1343 Valid WURFL properties are:
1344 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1345
1346 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1347 device.
1348
1349 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1350 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1351
1352 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1353 particular web request.
1354
1355 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1356 used Libwurfl API version.
1357
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001358 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1359 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1360
1361 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1362 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1363
1364 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1365
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001366 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1367 with USE_WURFL=1.
1368
1369wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1370 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1371 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1372
1373 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1374 with USE_WURFL=1.
1375
1376wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1377 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1378 thus before the chroot.
1379
1380 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1381 with USE_WURFL=1.
1382
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001383wurfl-cache-size <size>
1384 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1385 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001386 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001387 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001388
1389 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1390 with USE_WURFL=1.
1391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013923.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001393-----------------------
1394
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001395busy-polling
1396 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1397 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1398 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1399 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1400 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1401 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1402 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1403 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1404 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1405 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1406 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1407 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1408 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1409 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1410 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1411 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1412 "poll" pollers.
1413
William Dauchy857b9432019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001414 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1415 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1416 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1417
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001418max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1419 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1420 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1421 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1422 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1423 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1424 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1425 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1426 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1427
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001428maxconn <number>
1429 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1430 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1431 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001432 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1433 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1434 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1435 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001436 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1437 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1438 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1439 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1440 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1441 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001442
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001443maxconnrate <number>
1444 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1445 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1446 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1447 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1448 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1449 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1450 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1451 fairness.
1452
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001453maxcomprate <number>
1454 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001455 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001456 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1457 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1458 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001459 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001460 default value.
1461
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001462maxcompcpuusage <number>
1463 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1464 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1465 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1466 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1467 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1468 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1469 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1470 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1471
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001472maxpipes <number>
1473 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1474 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1475 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1476 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1477 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1478 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1479
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001480maxsessrate <number>
1481 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1482 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1483 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1484 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1485 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1486 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1487 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1488 fairness.
1489
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001490maxsslconn <number>
1491 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1492 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1493 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1494 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1495 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1496 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1497 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001498 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1499 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1500 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1501 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1502 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1503 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1504 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001505
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001506maxsslrate <number>
1507 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1508 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1509 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1510 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1511 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1512 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1513 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1514 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1515 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1516 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1517
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001518maxzlibmem <number>
1519 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1520 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1521 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001522 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1523 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1524 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1525
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001526noepoll
1527 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1528 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001529 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001530
1531nokqueue
1532 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1533 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1534 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1535
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001536noevports
1537 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1538 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1539 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1540 also "nopoll".
1541
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001542nopoll
1543 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1544 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001545 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001546 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1547 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001548
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001549nosplice
1550 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001551 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001552 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001553 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001554 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1555 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1556 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1557 "option splice-response".
1558
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001559nogetaddrinfo
1560 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1561 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1562
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001563noreuseport
1564 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1565 command line argument "-dR".
1566
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001567profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1568 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1569 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1570 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1571 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001572 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001573 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1574 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1575 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1576 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1577
1578 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1579 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1580 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1581 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1582 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001583 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1584 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1585 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1586 CLI.
1587
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001588spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001589 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1590 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1591 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1592 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1593 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1594 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001595
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001596ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001597 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001598 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001599 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1600 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1601 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1602 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1603 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001604 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1605 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001606 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1607 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1608 openssl configuration file uses:
1609 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1610
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001611ssl-mode-async
1612 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001613 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001614 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1615 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1616 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001617 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001618 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001619
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001620tune.buffers.limit <number>
1621 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1622 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1623 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1624 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1625 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001626 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001627 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1628 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1629 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1630 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1631 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1632 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1633 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1634 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1635 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1636
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001637tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1638 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1639 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1640 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1641 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1642
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001643tune.bufsize <number>
1644 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1645 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1646 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1647 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1648 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1649 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1650 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001651 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1652 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1653 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001654 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001655 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1656 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1657 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001658
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001659tune.chksize <number>
1660 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1661 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1662 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1663 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1664 checks whenever possible.
1665
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001666tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1667 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1668 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1669 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1670 this value. The default value is 1.
1671
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001672tune.fail-alloc
1673 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1674 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1675 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1676 gracefully.
1677
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001678tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1679 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1680 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1681 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1682 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1683 change it.
1684
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001685tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1686 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001687 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1688 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001689 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1690 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1691 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1692 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1693 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1694
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001695tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1696 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1697 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1698 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1699 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1700 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1701 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1702 recommended not to change this value.
1703
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001704tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1705 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1706 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1707 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1708 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1709 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1710 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1711 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1712
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001713tune.http.cookielen <number>
1714 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1715 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1716 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1717 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1718 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1719 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1720 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1721 to change this value.
1722
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001723tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001724 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1725 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001726 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001727 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001728 configuration directives too.
1729 The default value is 1024.
1730
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001731tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1732 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1733 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1734 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1735 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1736 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1737 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001738 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1739 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1740 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001741
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001742tune.idletimer <timeout>
1743 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1744 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1745 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1746 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1747 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1748 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001749 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001750 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001751 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1752
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001753tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1754 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1755 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1756 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1757 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1758 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1759 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1760 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1761 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1762 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1763
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001764tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1765 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001766 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001767 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1768 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001769 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001770 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1771 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1772
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001773tune.lua.maxmem
1774 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1775 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1776 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1777 memory.
1778
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001779tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1780 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001781 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1782 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001783 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001784
1785tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1786 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1787 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1788 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1789 check servers.
1790
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001791tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1792 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1793 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1794 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001795 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001796
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001797tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001798 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1799 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1800 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1801 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1802 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1803 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1804 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1805 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1806 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1807 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001808
1809tune.maxpollevents <number>
1810 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1811 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1812 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1813 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1814 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1815
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001816tune.maxrewrite <number>
1817 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1818 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1819 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1820 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1821 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1822 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1823 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1824 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1825 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1826 bufsize.
1827
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001828tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1829 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1830 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1831 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1832 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1833 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1834 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1835 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1836 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1837 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau7fdd81c2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001838 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1839 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001840 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1841 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1842 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1843 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1844 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1845 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1846 setting this parameter to 0.
1847
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001848tune.pipesize <number>
1849 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1850 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1851 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1852 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1853 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1854 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1855
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001856tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1857 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1858 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1859 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1860 default is 20.
1861
1862tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1863 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1864 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1865 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1866 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1867 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1868 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001869 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001870
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001871tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1872tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1873 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1874 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1875 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001876 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001877 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001878 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1879 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1880
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001881tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001882 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001883 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1884 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1885 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1886 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1887
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001888tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001889 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001890 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1891 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1892
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001893tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1894tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1895 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1896 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1897 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001898 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001899 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001900 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1901 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1902 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1903 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1904 notifying haproxy again.
1905
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001906tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001907 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1908 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1909 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001910 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001911 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001912 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001913 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1914 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1915 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001916 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1917 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001918
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001919tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001920 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001921 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1922 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1923 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1924 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1925 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1926
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001927tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1928 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001929 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001930 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1931 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1932 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1933 being used for too long.
1934
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001935tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1936 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1937 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1938 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1939 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1940 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1941 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1942 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1943 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1944 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1945 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001946 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001947 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001948
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001949tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1950 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1951 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1952 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1953 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1954 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1955 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1956 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001957 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1958 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001959
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001960tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1961 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1962 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1963 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1964 1000 entries.
1965
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001966tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1967 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1968 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1969 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1970
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001971tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001972tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001973tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1974tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1975tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001976 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1977 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1978 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1979 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1980 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1981 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1982 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1983 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001984
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001985 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1986 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1987 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1988 all available space is consumed.
1989 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1990 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1991 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001992
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001993tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1994 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001995 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001996 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001997 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001998 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1999
2000tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2001 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2002 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002003 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2004 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020063.3. Debugging
2007--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002008
2009debug
2010 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2011 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2012 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2013 system startup.
2014
2015quiet
2016 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2017 line argument "-q".
2018
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020203.4. Userlists
2021--------------
2022It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2023http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2024it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2025
2026userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002027 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002028 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2029
2030group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002031 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002032 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2033 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2034
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002035user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2036 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002037 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2038 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002039 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2040 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2041 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2042 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002043
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002044 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2045 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2046 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2047 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2048 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2049 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2050 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2051 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2052 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002053
2054 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002055 userlist L1
2056 group G1 users tiger,scott
2057 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002058
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002059 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2060 user scott insecure-password elgato
2061 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002062
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002063 userlist L2
2064 group G1
2065 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002066
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002067 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2068 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2069 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002070
2071 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002072
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002073
20743.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002075----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002076It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2077several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2078instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2079values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2080automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2081In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2082using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2083tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2084reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2085Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2086that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2087each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002088
2089peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002090 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002091 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2092
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002093bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2094 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2095 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2096
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002097disabled
2098 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2099 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2100 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2101
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002102default-bind [param*]
2103 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2104
2105default-server [param*]
2106 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2107
2108 Arguments:
2109 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2110 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2111 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2112 details.
2113
2114
2115 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2116
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002117enable
2118 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2119
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002120peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002121 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2122 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2123 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2124 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2125 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2126 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2127
2128 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2129 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2130
2131 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2132 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2133 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2134 across all peers.
2135
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002136 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2137 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002138
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002139 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2140 "server" keyword explanation below).
2141
2142server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002143 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002144 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2145 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2146 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2147 of this "peers" section).
2148 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2149
2150
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002151 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002152 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002153 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002154 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2155 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2156 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002157
2158 backend mybackend
2159 mode tcp
2160 balance roundrobin
2161 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2162 stick on src
2163
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002164 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2165 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002166
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002167 Example:
2168 peers mypeers
2169 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2170 default-server ssl verify none
2171 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2172 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002173
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002174
2175table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2176 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2177
2178 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2179 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002180 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002181 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2182 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2183 "stick-table" keyword).
2184
2185 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2186 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2187 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2188 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2189 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2190 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2191 of the stick-table name as follows:
2192
2193 peers mypeers
2194 peer A ...
2195 peer B ...
2196 table t1 ...
2197
2198 frontend fe1
2199 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2200
2201 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2202 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2203
2204 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2205 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2206 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2207 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2208 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2209 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2210 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2211
2212 peers mypeers
2213 peer A ...
2214 peer B ...
2215 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2216
2217 backend t1
2218 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2219
2220 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2221 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2222 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2223
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022243.6. Mailers
2225------------
2226It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2227If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2228in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2229
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002230mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002231 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2232 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2233
2234mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2235 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2236
2237 Example:
2238 mailers mymailers
2239 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2240 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2241
2242 backend mybackend
2243 mode tcp
2244 balance roundrobin
2245
2246 email-alert mailers mymailers
2247 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2248 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2249
2250 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2251 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2252
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002253timeout mail <time>
2254 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2255 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2256 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2257 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2258
2259 Example:
2260 mailers mymailers
2261 timeout mail 20s
2262 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002263
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022643.7. Programs
2265-------------
2266In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2267master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2268managed the same way as the workers.
2269
2270During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2271sequence as a worker:
2272
2273 - the master is re-executed
2274 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2275 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2276 instance of the program
2277
2278During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2279
2280program <name>
2281 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2282 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2283 the management guide).
2284
2285command <command> [arguments*]
2286 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2287 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2288 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2289 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2290
2291option start-on-reload
2292no option start-on-reload
2293 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2294 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2295 program section.
2296
2297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022984. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002299----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002300
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002301Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002302 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002303 - frontend <name>
2304 - backend <name>
2305 - listen <name>
2306
2307A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2308its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2309section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002310section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002311
2312A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2313connections.
2314
2315A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2316to forward incoming connections.
2317
2318A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2319parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2320
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002321All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2322'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2323case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2324
2325Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2326logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2327proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2328However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2329name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2330
2331Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2332and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002333bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002334protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2335modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2336arbitrary criteria.
2337
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002338In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2339a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto599788e2019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002340the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002341
2342 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2343 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2344 between responses and new requests.
2345
2346 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2347 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2348 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002349 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2350 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2351 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2352 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002353
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002354 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2355 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2356 client-facing connection remains open.
2357
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002358 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2359 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002360
2361The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2362frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2363following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002364weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002365
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002366 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002367
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002368 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2369 ----+-----+-----+----
2370 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2371 ----+-----+-----+----
2372 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2373 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2374 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2375 ----+-----+-----+----
2376 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002377
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002378
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023804.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2381--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002383The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2384limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2385they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2386limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002387marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002388option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002389and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2390with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2391specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002392
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002393
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002394 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2395------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2396acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002397backlog X X X -
2398balance X - X X
2399bind - X X -
2400bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002401block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002402capture cookie - X X -
2403capture request header - X X -
2404capture response header - X X -
2405clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002406compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002407contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2408cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002409declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002410default-server X - X X
2411default_backend X X X -
2412description - X X X
2413disabled X X X X
2414dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002415email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002416email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002417email-alert mailers X X X X
2418email-alert myhostname X X X X
2419email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002420enabled X X X X
2421errorfile X X X X
2422errorloc X X X X
2423errorloc302 X X X X
2424-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2425errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002426force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002427filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002428fullconn X - X X
2429grace X X X X
2430hash-type X - X X
2431http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002432http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002433http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002434http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002435http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002436http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002437http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002438id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002439ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002440load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002441log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002442log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002443log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002444log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002445max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002446maxconn X X X -
2447mode X X X X
2448monitor fail - X X -
2449monitor-net X X X -
2450monitor-uri X X X -
2451option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2452option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2453option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2454option allbackups (*) X - X X
2455option checkcache (*) X - X X
2456option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2457option contstats (*) X X X -
2458option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2459option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002460-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2461option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002462option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2463option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002464option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002465option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002466option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002467option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002468option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002469option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002470option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002471option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002472option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002473option httpchk X - X X
2474option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002475option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002476option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002477option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002478option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002479option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002480option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2481option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2482option logasap (*) X X X -
2483option mysql-check X - X X
2484option nolinger (*) X X X X
2485option originalto X X X X
2486option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002487option pgsql-check X - X X
2488option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002489option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002490option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002491option smtpchk X - X X
2492option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2493option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2494option splice-request (*) X X X X
2495option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002496option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002497option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2498option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2499-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002500option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002501option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2502option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2503option tcpka X X X X
2504option tcplog X X X X
2505option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002506external-check command X - X X
2507external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002508persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2509rate-limit sessions X X X -
2510redirect - X X X
2511redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2512redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002513reqadd (deprecated) - X X X
2514reqallow (deprecated) - X X X
2515reqdel (deprecated) - X X X
2516reqdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2517reqiallow (deprecated) - X X X
2518reqidel (deprecated) - X X X
2519reqideny (deprecated) - X X X
2520reqipass (deprecated) - X X X
2521reqirep (deprecated) - X X X
2522reqitarpit (deprecated) - X X X
2523reqpass (deprecated) - X X X
2524reqrep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002525-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002526reqtarpit (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002527retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002528retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002529rspadd (deprecated) - X X X
2530rspdel (deprecated) - X X X
2531rspdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2532rspidel (deprecated) - X X X
2533rspideny (deprecated) - X X X
2534rspirep (deprecated) - X X X
2535rsprep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002536server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002537server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002538server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002539source X - X X
2540srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002541stats admin - X X X
2542stats auth X X X X
2543stats enable X X X X
2544stats hide-version X X X X
2545stats http-request - X X X
2546stats realm X X X X
2547stats refresh X X X X
2548stats scope X X X X
2549stats show-desc X X X X
2550stats show-legends X X X X
2551stats show-node X X X X
2552stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002553-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2554stick match - - X X
2555stick on - - X X
2556stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002557stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002558stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002559tcp-check connect - - X X
2560tcp-check expect - - X X
2561tcp-check send - - X X
2562tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002563tcp-request connection - X X -
2564tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002565tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002566tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002567tcp-response content - - X X
2568tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002569timeout check X - X X
2570timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002571timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002572timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2573timeout connect X - X X
2574timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2575timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2576timeout http-request X X X X
2577timeout queue X - X X
2578timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002579timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002580timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2581timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002582timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002583transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002584unique-id-format X X X -
2585unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002586use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002587use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002588------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2589 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002590
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025924.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2593---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002594
2595This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2596
2597
2598acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2599 Declare or complete an access list.
2600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2601 no | yes | yes | yes
2602 Example:
2603 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2604 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2605 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002607 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
2609
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002610backlog <conns>
2611 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2613 yes | yes | yes | no
2614 Arguments :
2615 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2616 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002617 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002618
2619 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2620 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2621 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2622 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2623 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2624 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2625 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2626 backlog parameter.
2627
2628 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2629 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2630 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2631
2632 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2633
2634
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002635balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002636balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2639 yes | no | yes | yes
2640 Arguments :
2641 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2642 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2643 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2644 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2645
2646 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2647 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2648 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2649 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002650 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002651 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002652 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2653 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2654 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2655 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2656 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2657 it, so that you don't worry.
2658
2659 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2660 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2661 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2662 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2663 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2664 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2665 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2666 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002667
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002668 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2669 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2670 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2671 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2672 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2673 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2674 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2675 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2676
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002677 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002678 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002679 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2680 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002681 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002682 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2683 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2684 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2685 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2686 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002687 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2688 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2689 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2690 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2691 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2692 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002693
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002694 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2695 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2696 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2697 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2698 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2699 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2700 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2701 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002702 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002703 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002704 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2705 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2706 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002707
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002708 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2709 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2710 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2711 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2712 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2713 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2714 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2715 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2716 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2717 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2718 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2719 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002720
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002721 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002722 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2723 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2724 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2725 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2726 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2727 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2728 URIs start with a leading "/".
2729
2730 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2731 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2732 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2733 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2734
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002735 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002736 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2737
2738 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002739 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2740 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002741 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2742 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2743 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2744 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002745 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002746 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2747 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002748
2749 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2750 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2751 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2752 server will receive the request.
2753
2754 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2755 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2756 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2757 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2758 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002759 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2760 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2761 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002762
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002763 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2764 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2765 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2766 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2767 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002769 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002770 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2771 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2772 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2773
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002774 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2775 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2776 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2777
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002778 random
2779 random(<draws>)
2780 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002781 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2782 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2783 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2784 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002785 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2786 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2787 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2788 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2789 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2790 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2791 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2792 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2793 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2794 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2795 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2796 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2797 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2798 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2799 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2800 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2801 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2802 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2803 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2804 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002805
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002806 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002807 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002808 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2809 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2810 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2811 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2812 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2813 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002814 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002815 used instead.
2816
2817 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2818 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2819 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2820 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2821
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002822 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2823 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2824 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2825
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002826 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002827
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002828 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002829 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2830 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002831
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002832 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2833 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2834 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002835
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002836 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002837 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002838 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2839 NTLM relies on.
2840
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002841 Examples :
2842 balance roundrobin
2843 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002844 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002845 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2846 balance hdr(host)
2847 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002848
2849 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2850 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2851
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002852 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002853 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2854 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2855 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2856 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2857
2858 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2859 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2860 defaults to 16 kB.
2861
2862 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2863 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2864
2865 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2866 Round Robin.
2867
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002868 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002869 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2870 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2871 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2872
2873 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2874
2875 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002876 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002877 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2878 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2879 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002880
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002881 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002882
2883
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002884bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2885bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002886 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2888 no | yes | yes | no
2889 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002890 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2891 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2892 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2893 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002894 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002895 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2896 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2897 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2898 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2899 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2900 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2901 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002902 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2903 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2904 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2905 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2906 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2907 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2908 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002909 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2910 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2911 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002912 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2913 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2914 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2915 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002916 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2917 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2918 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002919
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002920 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2921 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002922 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2923 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2924 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002925 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2926 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2927 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2928 the range.
2929
2930 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2931 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2932 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2933 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2934 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2935 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2936 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002937 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002938 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002939
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002940 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002941 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002942 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2943 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2944 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2945 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2946 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2947 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2948
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002949 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2950 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2951 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2952 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002953
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002954 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2955 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2956 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2957 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2958 in a frontend.
2959
2960 Example :
2961 listen http_proxy
2962 bind :80,:443
2963 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002964 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002965
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002966 listen http_https_proxy
2967 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002968 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002969
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002970 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2971 bind ipv6@:80
2972 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2973 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2974
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002975 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002976 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002977
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002978 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2979 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2980 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2981 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2982 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2983
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002984 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002985 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002986
2987
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002988bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002989 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2991 yes | yes | yes | yes
2992 Arguments :
2993 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2994 may be used to override a default value.
2995
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002996 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002997 option may be combined with other numbers.
2998
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002999 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003000 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3001 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3002 missing from all processes.
3003
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003004 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003005 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003006 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3007 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3008 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3009 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3010 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003011 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003012
3013 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3014 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3015 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3016 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3017 and 'even' instances.
3018
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003019 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3020 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3021 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3022 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003023
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003024 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3025 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3026
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003027 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3028 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3029 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3030
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003031 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3032 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3033
3034 Example :
3035 listen app_ip1
3036 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003037 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003038
3039 listen app_ip2
3040 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003041 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003042
3043 listen management
3044 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003045 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003046
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003047 listen management
3048 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3049 bind-process 1-4
3050
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003051 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003052
3053
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003054block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003055 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
3056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3057 no | yes | yes | yes
3058
3059 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
3060 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003061 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003062 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003063 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003064 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
3065 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
3066 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003067
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003068 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
3069 "http-request deny" instead.
3070
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003071 Example:
3072 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3073 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3074 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03003075 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
3076 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
3077 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003078
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003079 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
3080 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
3081 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003082
3083capture cookie <name> len <length>
3084 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3086 no | yes | yes | no
3087 Arguments :
3088 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3089 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3090 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3091 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003092 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003093
3094 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3095 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3096 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3097 right if it exceeds <length>.
3098
3099 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3100 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3101 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3102 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3103
3104 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3105 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3106 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3107
3108 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3109 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3110 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003111 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3112 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3113 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003114
3115 Example:
3116 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3117
3118 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003119 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003120
3121
3122capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003123 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3125 no | yes | yes | no
3126 Arguments :
3127 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003128 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003129 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3130 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3131 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3132
3133 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3134 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3135 it exceeds <length>.
3136
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003137 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3139 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003140 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3141 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3142 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3143 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003144 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003145 environments to find where the request came from.
3146
3147 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3148 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3149 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3150 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003151
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003152 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3153 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3154 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3155 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3156 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003157
3158 Example:
3159 capture request header Host len 15
3160 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003161 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003163 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003164 about logging.
3165
3166
3167capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003168 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3170 no | yes | yes | no
3171 Arguments :
3172 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003173 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003174 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3175 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3176 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3177
3178 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3179 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3180 it exceeds <length>.
3181
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003182 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003183 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3184 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3185 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003186 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3187 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3188 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3189 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003190
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003191 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3192 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3193 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3194 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3195 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003196
3197 Example:
3198 capture response header Content-length len 9
3199 capture response header Location len 15
3200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003201 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003202 about logging.
3203
3204
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003205clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003206 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3208 yes | yes | yes | no
3209 Arguments :
3210 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3211 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3212 as explained at the top of this document.
3213
3214 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3215 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3216 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3217 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3218 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3219 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3220 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3221 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003222 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003223 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003224 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003225
3226 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3227 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3228 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3229 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3230 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3231 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3232
3233 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3234 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3235
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003236 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3237 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003239compression algo <algorithm> ...
3240compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003241compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003242 Enable HTTP compression.
3243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3244 yes | yes | yes | yes
3245 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003246 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3247 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3248 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3249
3250 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003251 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3252 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3253 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003254
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003255 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003256 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003257
3258 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3259 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3260 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3261 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3262 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003263 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003264
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003265 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3266 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3267 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3268 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3269 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3270 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3271 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003272 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003273
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003274 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003275 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003276 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3277 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3278 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3279 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3280 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003281
3282 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3283 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3284 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3285 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3286 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003287 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3288 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3289 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3290 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3291 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003292 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3293 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003294
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003295 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003296 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3297 "Accept-Encoding" header
3298 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003299 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003300 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3301 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3302 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3303 "multipart"
3304 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3305 header
3306 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3307 and later
3308 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3309 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003310 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003311
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003312 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003313
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003314 Examples :
3315 compression algo gzip
3316 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003317
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003318
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003319contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003320 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3322 yes | no | yes | yes
3323 Arguments :
3324 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3325 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3326 as explained at the top of this document.
3327
3328 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003329 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003330 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003332 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3333 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3334 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3335
3336 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3337 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3338 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3339 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3340 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3341 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3342
3343 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3344 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3345 instead.
3346
3347 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3348 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3349
3350
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003351cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003352 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3353 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003354 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003355 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3357 yes | no | yes | yes
3358 Arguments :
3359 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3360 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3361 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3362 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3363 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3364 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003365 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003366 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3367 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3368
3369 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3370 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3371 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3372 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3373 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3374 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003375 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3376 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003377 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003378 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3379 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003380
3381 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003382 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003383
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003384 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003385 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003386 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003387 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003388 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3389 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3390 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3391 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3392 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3393 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3394 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003395
3396 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3397 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3398 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3399 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3400 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3401 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3402 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3403 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3404 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003405 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003406 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3407 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3408 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003409
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003410 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3411 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3412 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003413 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3414 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3415 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3416 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003417 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3418 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3419 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003420
3421 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3422 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3423 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3424 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3425 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3426 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3427 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3428 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3429 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3430
3431 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3432 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3433 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3434 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3435 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3436 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3437 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3438 persistence cookie in the cache.
3439 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3440
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003441 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3442 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3443 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3444 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3445 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003446 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003447 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3448 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3449 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3450 they logout.
3451
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003452 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3453 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3454 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3455 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3456
3457 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3458 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3459 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3460 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3461 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3462 this attribute.
3463
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003464 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003465 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003466 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3467 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3468 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3469 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3470 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3471 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003472
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003473 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3474 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3475 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3476 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3477 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3478 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3479 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3480 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003481 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003482 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3483 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3484 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3485 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3486 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3487 the site.
3488
3489 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3490 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3491 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3492 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3493 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3494 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3495 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3496 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3497 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3498 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3499 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3500 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3501 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003502 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003503 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3504 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3505
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003506 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3507 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3508 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3509 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3510 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3511 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3512
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003513 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3514 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3515 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3516 repeated.
3517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003518 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3519 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3520 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3521 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003522
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003523 Examples :
3524 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3525 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3526 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003527 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003528
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003529 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003530
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003531
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003532declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3533 Declares a capture slot.
3534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3535 no | yes | yes | no
3536 Arguments:
3537 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3538
3539 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3540 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3541 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3542 for use in the response.
3543
3544 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003545 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003546 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3547
3548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003549default-server [param*]
3550 Change default options for a server in a backend
3551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3552 yes | no | yes | yes
3553 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003554 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3555 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3556 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3557 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003558
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003559 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003560 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3561
3562 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003563
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003564
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003565default_backend <backend>
3566 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3568 yes | yes | yes | no
3569 Arguments :
3570 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3571
3572 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3573 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3574 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3575 will catch all undetermined requests.
3576
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003577 Example :
3578
3579 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3580 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3581 default_backend dynamic
3582
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003583 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003584
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003585
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003586description <string>
3587 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3589 no | yes | yes | yes
3590 Arguments : string
3591
3592 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3593 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3594 it describes.
3595 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3596
3597
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003598disabled
3599 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3601 yes | yes | yes | yes
3602 Arguments : none
3603
3604 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3605 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3606 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3607 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3608 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3609 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3610 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3611
3612 See also : "enabled"
3613
3614
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003615dispatch <address>:<port>
3616 Set a default server address
3617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3618 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003619 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003620
3621 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3622 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3623 during start-up.
3624
3625 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3626 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3627 possible with normal servers.
3628
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003629 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003630 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3631 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3632 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3633 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3634
3635 See also : "server"
3636
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003637
3638dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3639 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3641 yes | no | yes | yes
3642 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3643
3644 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003645 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003646 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3647 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003648 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003649 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003650
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003651enabled
3652 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3654 yes | yes | yes | yes
3655 Arguments : none
3656
3657 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3658 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3659
3660 See also : "disabled"
3661
3662
3663errorfile <code> <file>
3664 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3666 yes | yes | yes | yes
3667 Arguments :
3668 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003669 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3670 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003671
3672 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003673 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003674 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003675 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3676 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003677
3678 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3679 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3680 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3681
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003682 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3683
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003684 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3685 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3686 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3687 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3688
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003689 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3690 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003691 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003692 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3693 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3694 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3695
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003696 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3697 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3698 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003699 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003700 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3701
3702 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3703
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003704 Example :
3705 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003706 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003707 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3708 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3709
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003710
3711errorloc <code> <url>
3712errorloc302 <code> <url>
3713 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3715 yes | yes | yes | yes
3716 Arguments :
3717 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003718 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3719 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003720
3721 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3722 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3723 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3724 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003725 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003726
3727 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3728 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3729 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3730
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003731 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3732
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003733 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3734 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3735 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3736 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003737 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003738 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3739 request.
3740
3741 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3742
3743
3744errorloc303 <code> <url>
3745 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3747 yes | yes | yes | yes
3748 Arguments :
3749 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003750 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3751 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003752
3753 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3754 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3755 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3756 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003757 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003758
3759 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3760 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3761 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3762
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003763 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3764
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003765 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3766 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3767 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3768 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003769 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003770
3771 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3772
3773
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003774email-alert from <emailaddr>
3775 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003776 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003777 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3778 yes | yes | yes | yes
3779
3780 Arguments :
3781
3782 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3783
3784 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3785 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3786
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003787 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003788 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3789 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003790
3791
3792email-alert level <level>
3793 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3794 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3795 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3796 yes | yes | yes | yes
3797
3798 Arguments :
3799
3800 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3801 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3802 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3803
3804 By default level is alert
3805
3806 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3807 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3808 for the proxy.
3809
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003810 Alerts are sent when :
3811
3812 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3813 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3814 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3815 is notice or lower
3816 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3817 and a health check status update occurs
3818
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003819 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3820 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003821 section 3.6 about mailers.
3822
3823
3824email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3825 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3826 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3827 yes | yes | yes | yes
3828
3829 Arguments :
3830
3831 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3832
3833 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3834 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3835
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003836 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3837 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003838
3839
3840email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3841 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3842 mailers.
3843 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3844 yes | yes | yes | yes
3845
3846 Arguments :
3847
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003848 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003849
3850 By default the systems hostname is used.
3851
3852 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3853 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3854 for the proxy.
3855
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003856 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3857 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003858
3859
3860email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003861 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003862 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3863 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3864 yes | yes | yes | yes
3865
3866 Arguments :
3867
3868 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3869
3870 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3871 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3872
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003873 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003874 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3875
3876
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003877force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3878 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003880 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003881
3882 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3883 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3884 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3885 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3886 marked down for maintenance operations.
3887
3888 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3889 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3890 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3891 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3892 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3893 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3894 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3895 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3896 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3897
3898 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3899 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3900 is used.
3901
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003902 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003903 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003904
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003905
3906filter <name> [param*]
3907 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3909 no | yes | yes | yes
3910 Arguments :
3911 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3912 referenced in section 9.
3913
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003914 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003915 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003916 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3917 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003918
3919 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3920 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3921
3922 Example:
3923 listen
3924 bind *:80
3925
3926 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3927 filter compression
3928 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3929
3930 compression algo gzip
3931 compression offload
3932
3933 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3934
3935 See also : section 9.
3936
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003937
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003938fullconn <conns>
3939 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3941 yes | no | yes | yes
3942 Arguments :
3943 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3944 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3945
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003946 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003947 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003948 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003949 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3950 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3951 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3952 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3953 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003954 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003955
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003956 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3957 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003958 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3959 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3960 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003961
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003962 Example :
3963 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3964 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3965 # connections.
3966 backend dynamic
3967 fullconn 10000
3968 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3969 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3970
3971 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3972
3973
3974grace <time>
3975 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003977 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003978 Arguments :
3979 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3980 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3981 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3982
3983 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3984 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003985 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003986 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3987
3988 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3989 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3990 simplify it.
3991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003992
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003993hash-balance-factor <factor>
3994 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3996 yes | no | no | yes
3997 Arguments :
3998 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3999 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004000 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004001
4002 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4003 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4004 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4005 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4006 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4007 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4008 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4009
4010 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4011 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4012 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4013 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4014 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4015
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004016 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4017 consistent hashing mechanism.
4018
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004019 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4020
4021
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004022hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004023 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4025 yes | no | yes | yes
4026 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004027 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4028 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004029
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004030 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4031 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4032 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4033 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4034 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4035 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4036 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4037 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4038 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4039 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004040
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004041 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4042 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4043 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4044 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4045 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4046 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4047 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4048 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4049 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4050 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4051 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4052 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4053 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004054 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4055 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004056
4057 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4058
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004059 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004060 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4061 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4062 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004063 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4064 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4065 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004066
4067 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4068 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004069 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4070 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4071 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4072 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4073
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004074 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4075 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4076 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4077 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4078 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4079 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4080 parameter.
4081
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004082 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4083 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4084 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4085 used on strings.
4086
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004087 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4088
4089 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4090 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4091 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4092 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4093 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4094 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4095 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4096 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4097 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4098 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4099 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4100 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004101
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004102 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4103 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4104 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004105
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004106 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004107
4108
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004109http-check disable-on-404
4110 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004112 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004113 Arguments : none
4114
4115 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4116 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4117 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4118 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4119 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4120 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4121 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4122 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004123 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4124 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4125 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4126
4127 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4128
4129
4130http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004131 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004133 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004134 Arguments :
4135 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4136 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004137 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004138 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4139 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4140 details on the supported keywords.
4141
4142 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4143 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4144 with the usual backslash ('\').
4145
4146 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4147 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4148 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4149 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4150 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4151
4152 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004153 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004154 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4155 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4156 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4157
4158 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004159 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004160 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4161 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4162 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4163 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4164
4165 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004166 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004167 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4168 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4169 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4170 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4171 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004172 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004173 trace).
4174
4175 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004176 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004177 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4178 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4179 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4180 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4181 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004182 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004183
4184 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4185 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4186 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4187 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4188 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4189 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4190 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4191 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4192
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004193 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4194 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4195 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4196
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004197 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4198 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4199
4200 Examples :
4201 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004202 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004203
4204 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004205 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004206
4207 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004208 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004209
4210 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004211 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004212
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004213 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004214
4215
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004216http-check send-state
4217 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4219 yes | no | yes | yes
4220 Arguments : none
4221
4222 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4223 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4224 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4225 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4226 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4227
4228 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4229 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4230 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4231 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4232 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004233 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4234 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4235 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4236
4237 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4238 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4239 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4240
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004241 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4242 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4243 checked in multiple backends.
4244
4245 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4246 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4247
4248 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4249 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4250 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4251 one fails.
4252
4253 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4254 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4255 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4256
4257 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4258 server's queue.
4259
4260 Example of a header received by the application server :
4261 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4262 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4263
4264 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4265
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004266
4267http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004268 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4269
4270 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4271 no | yes | yes | yes
4272
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004273 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4274 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4275 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4276 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4277 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004278
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004279 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4280 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004281
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004282 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004284 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4285 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4286 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4287 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004289 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4290 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4291 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4292 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004293
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004294 Example:
4295 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4296 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4297 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004299 http-request allow if nagios
4300 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4301 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4302 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004303
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004304 Example:
4305 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4306 acl add path /addacl
4307 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004309 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004310
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004311 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4312 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004313
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004314 Example:
4315 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4316 acl setmap path /setmap
4317 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004318
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004319 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004321 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4322 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004324 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4325 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004327http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004328
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004329 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4330 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4331 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4332 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4333 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4334 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4335 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4336 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004338http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4341 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4342 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4343 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4344 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4345 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4346 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4347 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004348
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004349http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004351 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4352 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004353
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004354
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004355http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004357 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4358 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4359 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4360 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4361 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004362
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004363 Example:
4364 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4365 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004366
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004367http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004369 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004370
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004371http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4372 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004374 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4375 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4376 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4377 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4378 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4379 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4380 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4381 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4382 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004384 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4385 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4386 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann63b220d2020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004387 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4388
4389 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4390 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4391 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4392 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004393
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004394http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004396 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4397 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4398 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4399 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4400 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4401 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004402
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004403http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004405 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004406
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004407http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004408
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004409 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4410 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4411 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4412 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4413 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4414 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004415
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004416http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004417
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004418 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4419 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4420 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4421 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4422 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004423
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004424http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4425 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4426 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4427 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4428
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004429http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4430
4431 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4432 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4433 pointed by <resolvers>.
4434 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4435 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4436 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4437 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4438 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4439 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4440 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4441 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4442 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4443 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4444 to 0.0.0.0.
4445
4446 Example:
4447 resolvers mydns
4448 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4449 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4450 timeout retry 1s
4451 hold valid 10s
4452 hold nx 3s
4453 hold other 3s
4454 hold obsolete 0s
4455 accepted_payload_size 8192
4456
4457 frontend fe
4458 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4459 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4460 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4461
4462 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4463 # which mean DNS resolution error
4464 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4465
4466 default_backend be
4467
4468 backend b_503
4469 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4470 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4471 # 503 error page to end users
4472
4473 backend be
4474 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4475 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4476 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4477 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4478 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4479
4480 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4481 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4482
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004483http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4484
4485 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4486 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4487 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4488 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004489 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4490 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004491
4492 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4493
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004494http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004496 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4497 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4498 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4499 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4500 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004501
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004502http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004503
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004504 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4505 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4506 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4507 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004508
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004509http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4510 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004511
Ilya Shipitsin5c836fd2020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004512 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004513 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4514 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4515 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4516 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4517 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004518
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004519 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4520 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4521 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4522 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4523 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004524
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004525 Example:
4526 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4527
4528 # applied to:
4529 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4530
4531 # outputs:
4532 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4533
4534 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004535
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004536 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4537
4538 # applied to:
4539 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004540
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004541 # outputs:
4542 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004543
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004544http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4545 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4546
4547 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4548 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4549 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4550 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4551
4552 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4553 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4554 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4555
4556 Example:
4557 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4558 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4559
4560 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4561 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4562
4563 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4564 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4565 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4566 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4567
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004568http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4569 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4570
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004571 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4572 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4573 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4574 against.
4575
4576 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4577 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4578 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004579
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004580 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4581 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4582 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4583 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4584 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4585 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4586 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4587 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4588 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004589 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4590 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004591
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004592 Example:
4593 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4594 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004595
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004596 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4597 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004599http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4600 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004601
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004602 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4603 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4604 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4605 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004606
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004607 Example:
4608 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004609
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004610 # applied to:
4611 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004612
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004613 # outputs:
4614 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004616http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4617http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004619 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4620 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4621 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004622
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004623http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004625 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4626 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4627 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004629http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004631 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4632 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4633 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4634 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4635 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004637 Arguments:
4638 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4639 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004641 Example:
4642 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4643 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004644
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004645 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4646 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004648http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004649
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004650 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4651 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4652 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004654 Arguments:
4655 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4656 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004657
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004658 Example:
4659 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4660 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004662 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4663 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4664 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004665
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004666http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004667
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004668 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4669 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4670 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4671 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4672 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004674 Example:
4675 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4676 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4677 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4678 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4679 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4680 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4681 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4682 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4683 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004684
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004685http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004686
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004687 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4688 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4689 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4690 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4691 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004693http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4694 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004695
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004696 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4697 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4698 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4699 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4700 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4701 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4702 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4703 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4704 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004706http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004707
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004708 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4709 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4710 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4711 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4712 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4713 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4714 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004715
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004716http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004717
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004718 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4719 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4720 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004721
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004722http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004723
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004724 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4725 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4726 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4727 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4728 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4729 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4730 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4731 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004732
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004733http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004734
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004735 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4736 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4737 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4738 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4739 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4740 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004741
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004742 Example :
4743 # prepend the host name before the path
4744 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004745
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004746http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004748 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4749 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4750 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4751 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4752 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004753
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004754http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004755
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004756 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4757 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4758 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4759 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4760 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4761 values have higher priority.
4762 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4763 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4764 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4765 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4766 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004767
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004768http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004769
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004770 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4771 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4772 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4773 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4774 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4775 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4776 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004777
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004778 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004779
4780 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004781 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4782 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004783
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004784http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4785 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4786 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4787 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004788 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
4789 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004790
4791 Arguments :
4792 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4793 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004794
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004795 See also "option forwardfor".
4796
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004797 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004798 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4799 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4800
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004801 # After the masking this will track connections
4802 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
4803 http-request track-sc0 src
4804
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004805 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4806 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4807
4808http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4809
4810 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4811 expression.
4812
4813 Arguments:
4814 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4815 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004816
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004817 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004818 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4819 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4820
4821 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4822 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4823 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4824
4825http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4826
4827 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4828 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4829 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4830 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4831 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4832 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4833 information from the request.
4834
4835 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4836
4837http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4838
4839 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4840 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4841 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4842 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4843 path and the query string.
4844 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4845
4846http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4847
4848 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4849 inline.
4850
4851 Arguments:
4852 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4853 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4854 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4855 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4856 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4857 (request and response)
4858 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4859 processing
4860 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4861 processing
4862 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4863 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4864 and '_'.
4865
4866 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4867 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004868
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004869 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004870 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004871
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004872http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4873 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004874
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004875 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4876 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4877 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4878 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4879 agent name must be used.
4880
4881 Arguments:
4882 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4883
4884 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4885 configuration.
4886
4887http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4888
4889 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4890 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4891 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4892 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4893 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4894 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4895 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4896 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4897 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4898 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4899 action.
4900 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4901 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4902 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4903 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4904 you fully understand how it works.
4905
4906http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4907
4908 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4909 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4910 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4911 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4912 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4913 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4914 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4915 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4916 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4917 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4918 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4919 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4920 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4921
4922http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4923http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4924http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4925
4926 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4927 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4928 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4929 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4930 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4931 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4932 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4933 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4934 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4935 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4936 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4937 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4938
4939 Arguments :
4940 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4941 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4942 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4943 select which table entry to update the counters.
4944
4945 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4946 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4947 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4948 that table until the session ends.
4949
4950 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4951 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4952 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4953 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4954 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4955 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4956 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4957 useful information.
4958
4959 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4960 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4961 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4962 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4963 checks that make use of it.
4964
4965http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4966
4967 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004968
4969 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004970 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004971
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004972http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4973
4974 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
4975 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
4976 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
4977 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
4978 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
4979 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4980
4981 Arguments :
4982 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
4983
4984 Example:
4985 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
4986
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004987http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004988
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004989 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4990 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4991 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004992
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004993
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004994http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004995 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4996
4997 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4998 no | yes | yes | yes
4999
5000 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5001 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5002 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5003 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5004 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5005 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5006
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005007 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5008 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005009
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005010 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005011
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005012 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
5013 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
5014 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
5015 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005016
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005017 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
5018 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
5019 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
5020 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005021
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005022 Example:
5023 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005024
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005025 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005026
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005027 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5028 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005029
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005030 Example:
5031 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005032
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005033 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005034
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005035 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5036 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005037
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005038 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5039 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005041http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005042
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005043 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5044 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5045 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5046 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5047 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5048 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5049 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5050 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005052http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005054 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5055 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5056 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5057 example, or to pass some internal information.
5058 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5059 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5060 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005062http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005063
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005064 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5065 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005066
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005067http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005068
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005069 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005070
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005071http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005072
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005073 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5074 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5075 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5076 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5077 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5078 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5079 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005080
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005081 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5082 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5083 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5084 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5085 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann63b220d2020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005086
5087 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5088 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5089 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5090 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005091
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005092http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005093
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005094 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5095 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5096 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5097 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5098 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5099 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005100
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005101http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005103 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005104
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005105http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005106
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005107 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5108 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5109 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5110 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5111 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5112 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005113
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005114http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005115
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005116 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
5117 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005118
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005119http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005120
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005121 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5122 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5123 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5124 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5125 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5126 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005127
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005128http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5129 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005130
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005131 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5132 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005133
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005134 Example:
5135 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005136
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005137 # applied to:
5138 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005139
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005140 # outputs:
5141 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005142
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005143 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005144
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005145http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5146 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005147
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005148 This works like "http-response replace-value" except that it works on the
5149 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005150
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005151 Example:
5152 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005153
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005154 # applied to:
5155 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005156
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005157 # outputs:
5158 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005159
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005160http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5161http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005162
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005163 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5164 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5165 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005167http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005168
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005169 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
5170 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
5171 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005172
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005173http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005174
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005175 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5176 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5177 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5178 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5179 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005180
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005181 Arguments:
5182 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005184 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5185 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005186
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005187http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005188
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005189 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5190 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5191 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005192
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005193http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5194
5195 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5196 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5197 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5198 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5199 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5200
5201http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5202
5203 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5204 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5205 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5206 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5207 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5208 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5209 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5210 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5211 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5212
5213http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5214
5215 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5216 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5217 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5218 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5219 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5220 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5221 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5222
5223http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5224
5225 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5226 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5227 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5228 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5229 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5230 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5231 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5232 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5233
5234http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5235 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5236
5237 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5238 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5239 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5240 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005241
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005242 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005243 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5244 http-response set-status 431
5245 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5246 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005247
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005248http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005249
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005250 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5251 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5252 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5253 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5254 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5255 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5256 based on some information from the request.
5257
5258 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5259
5260http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5261
5262 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5263 inline.
5264
5265 Arguments:
5266 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5267 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5268 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5269 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5270 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5271 (request and response)
5272 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5273 processing
5274 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5275 processing
5276 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5277 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5278 and '_'.
5279
5280 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5281 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005282
5283 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005284 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005285
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005286http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005287
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005288 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5289 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5290 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5291 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5292 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5293 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5294 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5295 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5296 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5297 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5298 action.
5299 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5300 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5301 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5302 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5303 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005304
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005305http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5306http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5307http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005308
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005309 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5310 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5311 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5312 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5313 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5314 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5315
5316http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5317
5318 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5319 about <var-name>.
5320
5321 Example:
5322 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5323
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005324
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005325http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5326 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5327
5328 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5329 yes | no | yes | yes
5330
5331 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005332 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5333 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5334 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005335
5336 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5337
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005338 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5339 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5340 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5341 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5342 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5343 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5344 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5345 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5346 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5347 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005348
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005349 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5350 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5351 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5352 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5353 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5354 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5355 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5356 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005357
5358 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5359 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5360 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5361 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5362 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5363 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5364 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5365 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005366 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005367 downsides of rare connection failures.
5368
5369 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5370 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5371 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5372 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5373 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5374 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005375 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005376 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5377 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5378 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5379 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5380 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5381
5382 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005383 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5384 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5385 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005386
5387 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005388 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005389
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005390 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5391 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005392
Lukas Tribus79a56932019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005393 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005394
5395 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5396 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5397 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5398
5399 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5400
5401
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005402http-send-name-header [<header>]
5403 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005404 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5405 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005406 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005407 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5408
Willy Tarreaue0e32792019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005409 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5410 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5411 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5412 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5413 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5414 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5415 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5416 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5417 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5418 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5419 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5420 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5421 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5422 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5423 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5424 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005425
5426 See also : "server"
5427
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005428id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005429 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5431 no | yes | yes | yes
5432 Arguments : none
5433
5434 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5435 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5436 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005437
5438
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005439ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5440 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5441 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005442 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005443
5444 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5445 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5446 and running).
5447
5448 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5449 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5450 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005451 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005452 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5453
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005454 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5455 "unless" condition is met.
5456
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005457 Example:
5458 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5459 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5460 ignore-persist if url_static
5461
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005462 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5463
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005464load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5465 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5466 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5467 yes | no | yes | yes
5468
5469 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5470 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5471 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005472 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005473 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5474 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5475 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5476 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5477
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005478 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005479 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005480 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005481
5482 Arguments:
5483 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5484 named "server-state-file".
5485
5486 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5487 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5488 name is used as a file name.
5489
5490 none don't load any stat for this backend
5491
5492 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005493 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5494 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5495 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005496 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005497 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005498
5499 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5500 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5501
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005502 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005503
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005504 global
5505 stats socket /tmp/socket
5506 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005507
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005508 defaults
5509 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005510
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005511 backend bk
5512 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5513 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005514
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005515
5516 Then one can run :
5517
5518 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5519
5520 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5521
5522 1
5523 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5524 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5525 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5526
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005527 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005528
5529 global
5530 stats socket /tmp/socket
5531 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5532
5533 defaults
5534 load-server-state-from-file local
5535
5536 backend bk
5537 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5538 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5539
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005540
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005541 Then one can run :
5542
5543 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5544
5545 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5546
5547 1
5548 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5549 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5550 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5551
5552 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5553 "show servers state"
5554
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005555
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005556log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005557log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5558 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005559no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005560 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5562 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005563
5564 Prefix :
5565 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5566 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5567 prefix does not allow arguments.
5568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005569 Arguments :
5570 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5571 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5572 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5573 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5574 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5575 parameter.
5576
5577 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5578 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5579
5580 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5581 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5582 standard syslog port).
5583
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005584 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5585 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5586 standard syslog port).
5587
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005588 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5589 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5590 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005591 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005592
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005593 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5594 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5595 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5596 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5597 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5598 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5599 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5600 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5601 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5602 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5603 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5604 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5605 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5606 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5607 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5608 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005609 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5610 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005611
5612 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5613 and "fd@2", see above.
5614
5615 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5616 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005617
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005618 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5619 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5620 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5621 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5622 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5623 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5624 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5625 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5626 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5627 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005628 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005629
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005630 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5631 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5632 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5633 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5634 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5635
5636 <sample_size>
5637 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5638 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5639 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5640 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5641 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5642
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005643 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5644 one of the following :
5645
5646 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5647 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5648
5649 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5650 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5651
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005652 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5653 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5654 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5655 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5656 systemd logger consumes.
5657
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005658 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5659 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5660 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5661 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5662
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005663 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5664
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005665 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5666 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5667 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5668
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005669 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5670 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5671 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5672 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005673
5674 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5675 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5676 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005677 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5678 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5679 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5680 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5681 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005682
5683 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5684
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005685 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5686 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5687 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005688
5689 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5690 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5691 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5692 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5693
5694 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5695 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005696
5697 Example :
5698 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005699 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5700 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5701 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005702 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5703 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005704 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005705
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005706
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005707log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005708 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5709 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5710 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005711
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005712 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5713 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5714 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5715 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5716 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005717
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005718 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5719 "option httplog" directives.
5720
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005721log-format-sd <string>
5722 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5723 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5724 yes | yes | yes | no
5725
5726 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5727 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5728 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5729 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5730 which covers the log format string in depth.
5731
5732 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5733 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5734
5735 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5736 log format to "rfc5424".
5737
5738 Example :
5739 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5740
5741
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005742log-tag <string>
5743 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5744 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5745 yes | yes | yes | yes
5746
5747 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5748 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5749 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5750 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5751 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5752 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5753 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5754 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5755 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005756
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005757max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5758 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5759 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5760 yes | no | yes | yes
5761
5762 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5763 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5764 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5765 servers.
5766
5767 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5768 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5769 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5770 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5771 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005772 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005773 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5774 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5775 picking a different server.
5776
5777 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5778 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5779 even if they have to be queued.
5780
5781 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5782 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5783
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005784max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5785 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5786 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5787 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005788
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005789maxconn <conns>
5790 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5792 yes | yes | yes | no
5793 Arguments :
5794 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5795 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5796 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5797 closes.
5798
5799 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5800 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5801 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5802 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005803 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5804 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5805 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5806 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005807
5808 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5809 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5810 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5811
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005812 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5813 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005814
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005815 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5816
5817
5818mode { tcp|http|health }
5819 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5821 yes | yes | yes | yes
5822 Arguments :
5823 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5824 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5825 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5826 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5827
5828 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5829 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5830 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5831 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5832 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5833
5834 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005835 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5836 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5837 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5838 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5839 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5840 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5841 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005842
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005843 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5844 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5845 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005846
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005847 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005848 defaults http_instances
5849 mode http
5850
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005851 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005852
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005853
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005854monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005855 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5857 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005858 Arguments :
5859 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5860 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005861 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005862 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5863 backend and its backup.
5864
5865 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5866 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5867 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5868 servers in a list of backends.
5869
5870 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5871 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5872 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5873 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5874 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5875 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5876 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005877 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5878 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005879
5880 Example:
5881 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005882 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005883 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5884 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5885 monitor-uri /site_alive
5886 monitor fail if site_dead
5887
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005888 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005889
5890
5891monitor-net <source>
5892 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5894 yes | yes | yes | no
5895 Arguments :
5896 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5897 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5898 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5899 followed by a mask.
5900
5901 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5902 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005903 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005904 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5905
5906 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5907 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5908 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5909 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005910 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5911 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5912 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005913
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005914 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5915 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5916 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5917 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5918 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5919 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005920
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005921 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5922 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005923
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005924 Example :
5925 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5926 frontend www
5927 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5928
5929 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5930
5931
5932monitor-uri <uri>
5933 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5935 yes | yes | yes | no
5936 Arguments :
5937 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5938 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5939
5940 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5941 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5942 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5943 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5944 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5945 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5946 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5947 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5948
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005949 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5950 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5951 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5952 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5953 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5954 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5955 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5956 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005957
5958 Example :
5959 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5960 frontend www
5961 mode http
5962 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5963
5964 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5965
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005966
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005967option abortonclose
5968no option abortonclose
5969 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5971 yes | no | yes | yes
5972 Arguments : none
5973
5974 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5975 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5976 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5977 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005978 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005979 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5980 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5981 encountered while delivering the response.
5982
5983 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5984 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5985 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5986 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5987 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5988 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005989 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005990 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005991 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005992 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5993 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5994 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5995
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005996 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5997 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005998 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5999 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6000 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6001 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6002 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6003 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006004 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006005
6006 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6007 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6008
6009 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6010
6011
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006012option accept-invalid-http-request
6013no option accept-invalid-http-request
6014 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6016 yes | yes | yes | no
6017 Arguments : none
6018
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006019 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006020 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006021 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006022 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6023 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6024 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6025 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6026 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006027 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6028 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6029 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6030 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006031 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006032 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006033 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6034 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6035 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006036
6037 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6038 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6039 been confirmed.
6040
6041 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6042 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006043 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6044 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006045 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6046
6047 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6048 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6049
6050 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6051 stats socket.
6052
6053
6054option accept-invalid-http-response
6055no option accept-invalid-http-response
6056 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6058 yes | no | yes | yes
6059 Arguments : none
6060
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006061 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006062 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006063 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006064 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6065 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6066 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6067 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6068 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006069 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6070 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6071 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006072
6073 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6074 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6075 been confirmed.
6076
6077 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6078 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6079 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6080 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6081
6082 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6083 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6084
6085 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6086 stats socket.
6087
6088
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006089option allbackups
6090no option allbackups
6091 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6093 yes | no | yes | yes
6094 Arguments : none
6095
6096 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6097 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6098 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6099 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6100 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6101 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6102 order between the backup servers anymore.
6103
6104 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6105 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6106
6107 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6108 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6109
6110
6111option checkcache
6112no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006113 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6115 yes | no | yes | yes
6116 Arguments : none
6117
6118 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6119 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006120 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006121 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6122 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006123 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006124
6125 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006126 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006127 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006128 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6129 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006130 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006131 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006132 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6133 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006134 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006135 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6136 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006137 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006138 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6139 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6140 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6141 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6142 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6143 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6144 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6145 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6146 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6147
6148 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006149 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006150 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006151 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006152 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
6153
6154 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6155 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006156 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006157 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006158
6159 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6160 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6161
6162
6163option clitcpka
6164no option clitcpka
6165 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6167 yes | yes | yes | no
6168 Arguments : none
6169
6170 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6171 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006172 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006173 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6174
6175 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6176 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6177 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6178 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6179
6180 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6181 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6182 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6183 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6184 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6185
6186 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6187
6188 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6189 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6190 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6191
6192 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6193 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6194
6195 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6196
6197
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006198option contstats
6199 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6201 yes | yes | yes | no
6202 Arguments : none
6203
6204 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6205 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6206 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6207 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006208 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6209 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6210 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6211 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6212 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006213
6214
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006215option dontlog-normal
6216no option dontlog-normal
6217 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6219 yes | yes | yes | no
6220 Arguments : none
6221
6222 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6223 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6224 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6225 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6226 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6227 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6228 logged.
6229
6230 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6231 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6232 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6233
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006234 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006235 logging.
6236
6237
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006238option dontlognull
6239no option dontlognull
6240 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6242 yes | yes | yes | no
6243 Arguments : none
6244
6245 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6246 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6247 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6248 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6249 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6250 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006251 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6252 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6253 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006254
6255 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006256 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006257 would not be logged.
6258
6259 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6260 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6261
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006262 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6263 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006264
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006265
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006266option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006267 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6269 yes | yes | yes | yes
6270 Arguments :
6271 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6272 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006273 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006274 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006275
6276 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6277 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6278 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6279 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6280 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6281 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6282 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006283 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6284 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6285 possible that the client has already brought one.
6286
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006287 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006288 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006289 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006290 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006291 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006292 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006293
6294 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6295 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6296 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6297 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6298 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6299 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6300 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6301
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006302 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6303 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6304 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6305 are under the control of the end-user.
6306
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006307 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006308 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6309 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006310 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6311 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6312 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006313
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006314 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006315 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6316 frontend www
6317 mode http
6318 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6319
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006320 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6321 backend www
6322 mode http
6323 option forwardfor header X-Client
6324
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006325 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006326 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006327
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006328
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006329option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6330no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6331 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6333 yes | yes | yes | no
6334 Arguments : none
6335
6336 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6337 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6338 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6339 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6340 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6341 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6342 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6343
6344 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6345 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6346 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6347 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6348 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6349 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6350 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6351 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6352 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6353 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6354
6355 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6356
6357 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6358 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6359
6360 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6361 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6362
6363
6364option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6365no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6366 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6368 yes | no | yes | yes
6369 Arguments : none
6370
6371 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6372 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6373 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6374 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6375 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6376 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6377 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6378
6379 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6380 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6381 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6382 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6383 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6384 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6385 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6386 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6387 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6388 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6389
6390 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6391
6392 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6393 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6394
6395 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6396 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6397
6398
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006399option http-buffer-request
6400no option http-buffer-request
6401 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6403 yes | yes | yes | yes
6404 Arguments : none
6405
6406 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6407 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6408 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6409 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6410 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6411 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6412 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6413 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006414 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006415 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6416 default.
6417
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006418 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006419
6420
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006421option http-ignore-probes
6422no option http-ignore-probes
6423 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6425 yes | yes | yes | no
6426 Arguments : none
6427
6428 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6429 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6430 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6431 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6432 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6433 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6434 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6435 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6436 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006437 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6438 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006439 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6440
6441 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6442 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6443 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6444 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6445 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6446 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6447 are often the only way to detect them.
6448
6449 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6450 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6451
6452 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6453
6454
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006455option http-keep-alive
6456no option http-keep-alive
6457 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6459 yes | yes | yes | yes
6460 Arguments : none
6461
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006462 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6463 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006464 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6465 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6466 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6467 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6468 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006469
6470 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6471 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006472 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6473 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6474 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6475 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6476 situations where this option may be useful :
6477
6478 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006479 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006480
6481 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6482 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6483
6484 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6485 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6486 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6487 request.
6488
6489 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6490 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006491 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6492 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6493 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006494
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006495 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6496 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6497 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6498 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6499 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6500 not set.
6501
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006502 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006503 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6504 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006505
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006506 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006507 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006508 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006509
6510
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006511option http-no-delay
6512no option http-no-delay
6513 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6515 yes | yes | yes | yes
6516 Arguments : none
6517
6518 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6519 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6520 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6521 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6522 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6523 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6524 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6525 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6526 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6527 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6528 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6529 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6530 affected.
6531
6532 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6533 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6534 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6535 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6536 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6537 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6538 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6539 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6540 latency environments.
6541
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006542 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6543
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006544
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006545option http-pretend-keepalive
6546no option http-pretend-keepalive
6547 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006549 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006550 Arguments : none
6551
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006552 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006553 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6554 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6555 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6556 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6557 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6558 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6559 consider the response complete.
6560
6561 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6562 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6563 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6564 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006565 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006566 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6567
6568 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6569 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6570 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6571 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6572 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6573 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6574 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6575
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006576 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6577 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6578 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6579 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6580 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6581 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006582
6583 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6584 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6585
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006586 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006587 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006588
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006589
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006590option http-server-close
6591no option http-server-close
6592 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6594 yes | yes | yes | yes
6595 Arguments : none
6596
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006597 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6598 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6599 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6600 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006601 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6602 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6603 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6604 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6605 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6606 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6607 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6608 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6609 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6610 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6611 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006612
6613 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6614 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6615 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6616 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006617 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6618 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006619
6620 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6621 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006622 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6623 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6624 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006625
6626 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6627 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6628
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006629 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6630 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006631
6632
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006633option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6634no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6635 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006637 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006638 Arguments : none
6639
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006640 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6641 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6642 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6643
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006644 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6645 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6646 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6647 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006648 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006649
6650 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006651 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006652 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6653 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6654 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6655 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6656 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6657 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6658 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006659
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006660 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6661 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6662 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6663 backend.
6664
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006665 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6666 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6667
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006668 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6669 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006670
6671
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006672option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006673no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006674 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6676 yes | yes | yes | no
6677 Arguments : none
6678
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006679 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006680 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6681 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6682 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6683 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6684 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6685 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6686
6687 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6688 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006689 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6690 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6691 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006692
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006693 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6694 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6695 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6696 front of an existing proxy.
6697
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006698 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6699
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006700 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006701
6702
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006703option http-use-htx
6704no option http-use-htx
6705 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6707 yes | yes | yes | yes
6708 Arguments : none
6709
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006710 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006711 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006712 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6713 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6714 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6715 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6716 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006717
6718 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6719 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6720 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6721 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006722 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6723 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6724 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6725 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006726
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006727 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6728 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6729 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6730 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6731 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006732
6733 See also : "mode http"
6734
6735
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006736option httpchk
6737option httpchk <uri>
6738option httpchk <method> <uri>
6739option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6740 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6742 yes | no | yes | yes
6743 Arguments :
6744 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6745 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6746 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6747 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6748 ones.
6749
6750 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6751 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6752 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6753
6754 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6755 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6756 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6757 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6758 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6759
6760 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6761 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6762 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6763 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6764 the lack of any response.
6765
6766 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6767
6768 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6769 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6770 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6771
6772 Examples :
6773 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6774 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6775 backend https_relay
6776 mode tcp
6777 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6778 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6779
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006780 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6781 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6782 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006783
6784
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006785option httpclose
6786no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006787 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6789 yes | yes | yes | yes
6790 Arguments : none
6791
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006792 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6793 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6794 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6795 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006796 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006797
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006798 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6799 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006800 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006801 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6802 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006803
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006804 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6805 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6806 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006807
6808 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6809 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006810 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006811 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6812 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6813 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006814
6815 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6816 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6817
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006818 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006819
6820
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006821option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006822 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006824 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006825 Arguments :
6826 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6827 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6828 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006829 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006830 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006831
6832 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6833 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6834 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6835 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6836 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6837 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6838 ports.
6839
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006840 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6841 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006842
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006843 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6844
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006845 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006846
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006847
6848option http_proxy
6849no option http_proxy
6850 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6852 yes | yes | yes | yes
6853 Arguments : none
6854
6855 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6856 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6857 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6858 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6859 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6860
6861 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6862 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006863 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6864 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006865
6866 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6867 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6868
6869 Example :
6870 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6871 backend direct_forward
6872 option httpclose
6873 option http_proxy
6874
6875 See also : "option httpclose"
6876
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006877
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006878option independent-streams
6879no option independent-streams
6880 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6882 yes | yes | yes | yes
6883 Arguments : none
6884
6885 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6886 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6887 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6888 receive data or not.
6889
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006890 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006891 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6892 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6893 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6894 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6895 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6896 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6897 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6898 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6899 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6900 socket buffers.
6901
6902 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6903 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6904 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6905 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6906 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6907
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006908 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006909 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6910 deprecated.
6911
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006912 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006913
6914
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006915option ldap-check
6916 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6918 yes | no | yes | yes
6919 Arguments : none
6920
6921 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6922 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6923 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6924 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6925
6926 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6927 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6928
6929 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6930 configure it.
6931
6932 Example :
6933 option ldap-check
6934
6935 See also : "option httpchk"
6936
6937
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006938option external-check
6939 Use external processes for server health checks
6940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6941 yes | no | yes | yes
6942
6943 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6944 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6945 command".
6946
6947 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6948
6949 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6950
6951
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006952option log-health-checks
6953no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006954 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6956 yes | no | yes | yes
6957 Arguments : none
6958
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006959 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6960 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6961 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006962
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006963 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6964 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6965 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6966 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6967 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6968
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006969 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006970 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006971
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006972 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6973 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6974 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006975
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006976
6977option log-separate-errors
6978no option log-separate-errors
6979 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6981 yes | yes | yes | no
6982 Arguments : none
6983
6984 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6985 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6986 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6987 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6988 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6989 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6990 provides very important information.
6991
6992 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6993 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6994 error logs.
6995
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006996 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006997 logging.
6998
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006999
7000option logasap
7001no option logasap
Jerome Magnina1d4a732020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007002 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7004 yes | yes | yes | no
7005 Arguments : none
7006
Jerome Magnina1d4a732020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007007 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7008 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7009 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7010 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7011
7012 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7013 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7014 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7015 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7016 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
7017 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transfered
7018 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7019 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7020 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7021 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
7022 transfered.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007023
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007024 Examples :
7025 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7026 mode http
7027 option httplog
7028 option logasap
7029 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7030
7031 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7032 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7033 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7034 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7035
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007036 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007037 logging.
7038
7039
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007040option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007041 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7043 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007044 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007045 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7046 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007047 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007048
7049 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7050 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007051 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007052 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7053 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7054 in the MySQL table, like this :
7055
7056 USE mysql;
7057 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7058 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7059
7060 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007061 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007062 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7063 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7064 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7065 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7066 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7067 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7068 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7069
7070 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7071 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007072
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007073 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007074
7075 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7076 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7077 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7078 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007079 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7080 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007081
7082 See also: "option httpchk"
7083
7084
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007085option nolinger
7086no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007087 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007088 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7089 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007090 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007091
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007092 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007093 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7094 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7095 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7096 connections.
7097
7098 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7099 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7100 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7101 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7102 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7103 this too.
7104
7105 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7106 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7107 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7108
7109 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7110 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7111 for servers.
7112
7113 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7114 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7115
7116
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007117option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7118 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7120 yes | yes | yes | yes
7121 Arguments :
7122 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7123 matching <network>
7124 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7125 header name.
7126
7127 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7128 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7129 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7130 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7131 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7132 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7133 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7134 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7135 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7136 possible that the client has already brought one.
7137
7138 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7139 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7140 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7141 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7142 header and requires different one.
7143
7144 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7145 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7146 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7147 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7148 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7149 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7150 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7151
7152 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7153 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7154 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7155 both are defined.
7156
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007157 Examples :
7158 # Original Destination address
7159 frontend www
7160 mode http
7161 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7162
7163 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7164 backend www
7165 mode http
7166 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7167
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007168 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007169
7170
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007171option persist
7172no option persist
7173 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7174 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7175 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007176 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007177
7178 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7179 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7180 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7181 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7182 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7183 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7184 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7185 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7186 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7187 redirected to another valid server.
7188
7189 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7190 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7191
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007192 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007193
7194
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007195option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7196 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7198 yes | no | yes | yes
7199 Arguments :
7200 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7201 PostgreSQL server.
7202
7203 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7204 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7205 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7206 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7207
7208 See also: "option httpchk"
7209
7210
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007211option prefer-last-server
7212no option prefer-last-server
7213 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7214 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7215 yes | no | yes | yes
7216 Arguments : none
7217
7218 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7219 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7220 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7221 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7222 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7223 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7224 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7225 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7226 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007227 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7228 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007229 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7230 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7231 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007232 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7233 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7234 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007235
7236 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7237 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7238
7239 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7240
7241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007242option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007243option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007244no option redispatch
7245 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7246 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7247 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007248 Arguments :
7249 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7250 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7251 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007252 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007253 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007254 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007255 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7256 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7257 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7258
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007259
7260 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7261 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7262 be able to access the service anymore.
7263
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007264 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7265 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007266
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007267 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007268 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7269 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007271 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
7272 "redisp" keywords.
7273
7274 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7275 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7276
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007277 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007278
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007279
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007280option redis-check
7281 Use redis health checks for server testing
7282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7283 yes | no | yes | yes
7284 Arguments : none
7285
7286 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7287 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7288 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7289 find the "+PONG" response message.
7290
7291 Example :
7292 option redis-check
7293
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007294 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007295
7296
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007297option smtpchk
7298option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7299 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7301 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007302 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007303 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007304 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007305 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7306
7307 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7308 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7309 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7310
7311 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7312 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7313 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7314 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7315 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7316 dead server.
7317
7318 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7319 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007320 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007321 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7322
7323 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7324 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7325 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7326 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007327 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007328
7329 Example :
7330 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7331
7332 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7333
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007334
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007335option socket-stats
7336no option socket-stats
7337
7338 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7340 yes | yes | yes | no
7341
7342 Arguments : none
7343
7344
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007345option splice-auto
7346no option splice-auto
7347 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7349 yes | yes | yes | yes
7350 Arguments : none
7351
7352 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7353 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007354 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007355 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007356 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007357 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7358 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7359 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7360 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7361
7362 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7363 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7364 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7365 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7366 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7367 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7368 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7369 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7370 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7371 keyword.
7372
7373 Example :
7374 option splice-auto
7375
7376 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7377 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7378
7379 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7380 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7381
7382
7383option splice-request
7384no option splice-request
7385 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7387 yes | yes | yes | yes
7388 Arguments : none
7389
7390 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007391 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007392 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7393 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7394 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7395 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7396
7397 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7398
7399 Example :
7400 option splice-request
7401
7402 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7403 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7404
7405 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7406 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7407
7408
7409option splice-response
7410no option splice-response
7411 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7413 yes | yes | yes | yes
7414 Arguments : none
7415
7416 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007417 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007418 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7419 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7420 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7421 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7422
7423 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7424
7425 Example :
7426 option splice-response
7427
7428 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7429 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7430
7431 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7432 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7433
7434
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007435option spop-check
7436 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7438 no | no | no | yes
7439 Arguments : none
7440
7441 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7442 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7443 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7444 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7445
7446 Example :
7447 option spop-check
7448
7449 See also : "option httpchk"
7450
7451
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007452option srvtcpka
7453no option srvtcpka
7454 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7456 yes | no | yes | yes
7457 Arguments : none
7458
7459 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7460 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007461 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007462 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7463
7464 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7465 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7466 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7467 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7468
7469 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7470 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7471 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7472 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7473 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7474
7475 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7476
7477 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7478 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7479 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7480
7481 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7482 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7483
7484 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7485
7486
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007487option ssl-hello-chk
7488 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7490 yes | no | yes | yes
7491 Arguments : none
7492
7493 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7494 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7495 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7496 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7497 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7498 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7499 hello message.
7500
7501 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7502 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7503 messages, which is appreciable.
7504
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007505 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7506 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7507 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007508
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007509 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7510
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007511
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007512option tcp-check
7513 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7514 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7515 yes | no | yes | yes
7516
7517 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7518 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7519
7520 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7521 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7522 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7523
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007524 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007525 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7526 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7527 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7528 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7529 only.
7530
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007531 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007532 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7533 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7534 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7535 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7536
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007537 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007538 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7539 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007540 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007541 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7542 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7543 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7544 the respective protocols.
7545 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007546 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007547
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007548 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7549 script.
7550
7551 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7552 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7553 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7554 The "comment" is of course optional.
7555
7556
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007557 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007558 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007559 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007560 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007561
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007562 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007563 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007564 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007565
7566 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7567 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007568 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007569 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007570 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007571 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007572 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007573 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007574 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7575 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007576 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007577 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7578 tcp-check expect string +OK
7579
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007580 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007581 (send many headers before analyzing)
7582 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007583 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007584 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7585 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7586 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7587 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007588 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007589
7590
7591 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7592
7593
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007594option tcp-smart-accept
7595no option tcp-smart-accept
7596 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7598 yes | yes | yes | no
7599 Arguments : none
7600
7601 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7602 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7603 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7604 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7605 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7606 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7607
7608 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7609 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7610 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7611 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7612
7613 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7614 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7615 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007616 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007617
7618 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7619 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7620 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7621
7622 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7623 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7624 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7625
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007626 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7627
7628
7629option tcp-smart-connect
7630no option tcp-smart-connect
7631 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7633 yes | no | yes | yes
7634 Arguments : none
7635
7636 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7637 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7638 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7639 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7640 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7641
7642 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7643 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7644 complex.
7645
7646 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7647 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7648 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7649
7650 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7651 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7652
7653 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7654
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007655
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007656option tcpka
7657 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7659 yes | yes | yes | yes
7660 Arguments : none
7661
7662 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7663 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007664 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007665 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7666
7667 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7668 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7669 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7670 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7671
7672 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7673 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7674 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7675 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7676 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7677
7678 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7679
7680 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7681 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7682 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7683 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7684 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7685 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7686 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7687 backends.
7688
7689 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7690
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007691
7692option tcplog
7693 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007695 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007696 Arguments : none
7697
7698 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7699 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7700 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7701 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7702 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7703 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7704 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7705 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7706
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007707 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007709 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007710
7711
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007712option transparent
7713no option transparent
7714 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007716 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007717 Arguments : none
7718
7719 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7720 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7721 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7722 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7723 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7724 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7725 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7726 appropriate server.
7727
7728 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7729 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7730
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007731 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007732 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007733
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007734
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007735external-check command <command>
7736 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7738 yes | no | yes | yes
7739
7740 Arguments :
7741 <command> is the external command to run
7742
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007743 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7744
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007745 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007746
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007747 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7748 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7749 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7750 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7751 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7752 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007753
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007754 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7755
7756 Environment variables :
7757 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7758 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7759
7760 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7761
7762 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7763
7764 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7765 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7766 for a UNIX socket).
7767
7768 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7769
7770 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7771
7772 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7773
7774 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7775
7776 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7777
7778 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7779 socket).
7780
7781 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7782 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7783
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007784 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7785
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007786 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7787 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7788 failed.
7789
7790 Example :
7791 external-check command /bin/true
7792
7793 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7794
7795
7796external-check path <path>
7797 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7799 yes | no | yes | yes
7800
7801 Arguments :
7802 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7803
7804 The default path is "".
7805
7806 Example :
7807 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7808
7809 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7810 "external-check command"
7811
7812
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007813persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007814persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007815 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7817 yes | no | yes | yes
7818 Arguments :
7819 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007820 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7821 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007822
7823 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7824 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007825 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007826 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7827 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7828 forwarded to this server.
7829
7830 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7831 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7832 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007833 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007834 a single "listen" section.
7835
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007836 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7837 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7838 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7839
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007840 Example :
7841 listen tse-farm
7842 bind :3389
7843 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7844 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7845 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7846 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7847 persist rdp-cookie
7848 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007849 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007850 balance rdp-cookie
7851 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7852 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7853
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007854 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7855 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007856
7857
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007858rate-limit sessions <rate>
7859 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7861 yes | yes | yes | no
7862 Arguments :
7863 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7864 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7865
7866 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7867 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7868 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7869 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7870 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7871 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7872
7873 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7874 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7875 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7876 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7877
7878 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7879 listen smtp
7880 mode tcp
7881 bind :25
7882 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007883 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007884
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007885 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7886 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7887 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007888
7889 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7890
7891
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007892redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7893redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7894redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007895 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7897 no | yes | yes | yes
7898
7899 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007900 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007901
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007902 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007903 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007904 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7905 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7906 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007907
7908 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7909 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7910 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7911 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7912 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007913 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7914 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7915 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7916 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007917
7918 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7919 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7920 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7921 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7922 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7923 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007924 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007925 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007926 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7927 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7928 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007929
7930 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007931 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7932 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7933 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007934 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007935 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7936 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7937 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7938 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007939
7940 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007941 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007942
7943 - "drop-query"
7944 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7945 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7946 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7947 with a location-type redirect.
7948
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007949 - "append-slash"
7950 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7951 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7952 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7953 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7954
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007955 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7956 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7957 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7958 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7959 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7960 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7961 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7962
7963 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7964 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7965 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7966 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7967 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7968 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7969 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007970
7971 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7972 acl clear dst_port 80
7973 acl secure dst_port 8080
7974 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007975 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007976 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007977 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7978
7979 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007980 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7981 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7982 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007983 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007984
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007985 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7986 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7987 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7988
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007989 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007990 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007991
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007992 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007993 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7994 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7995 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007996
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007997 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007998
7999
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008000redisp (deprecated)
8001redispatch (deprecated)
8002 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8003 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8004 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008005 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008006
8007 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8008 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8009 be able to access the service anymore.
8010
8011 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
8012 redistribute them to a working server.
8013
8014 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
8015 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8016 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008017
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008018 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
8019 "option redispatch" instead.
8020
8021 See also : "option redispatch"
8022
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008023
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008024reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008025 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
8026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8027 no | yes | yes | yes
8028 Arguments :
8029 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8030 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008031 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008032
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01008033 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8034 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8035
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008036 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8037 the last header of an HTTP request.
8038
8039 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8040 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8041 responses.
8042
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01008043 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
8044 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
8045 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
8046
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008047 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
8048 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008049
8050
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008051reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8052reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008053 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8055 no | yes | yes | yes
8056 Arguments :
8057 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8058 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8059 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8060 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8061 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8062 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
8063 ignores case.
8064
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008065 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8066 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8067
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008068 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8069 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
8070 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8071 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008072 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008073
8074 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8075 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8076
8077 Example :
8078 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
8079 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8080 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8081
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008082 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
8083 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008084
8085
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008086reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8087reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008088 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
8089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8090 no | yes | yes | yes
8091 Arguments :
8092 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8093 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8094 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8095 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8096 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
8097 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
8098
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008099 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8100 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8101
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008102 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
8103 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
8104 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
8105 next servers.
8106
8107 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8108 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8109 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8110
8111 Example :
8112 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
8113 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
8114 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
8115
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008116 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
8117 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008118
8119
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008120reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8121reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008122 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8124 no | yes | yes | yes
8125 Arguments :
8126 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8127 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8128 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8129 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8130 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8131 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
8132 case.
8133
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008134 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8135 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8136
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008137 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8138 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
8139 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8140 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008141 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008142
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008143 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008144 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008145 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008146
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008147 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8148 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8149
8150 Example :
8151 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
8152 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8153 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8154
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008155 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8156 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008157
8158
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008159reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8160reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008161 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
8162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8163 no | yes | yes | yes
8164 Arguments :
8165 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8166 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8167 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8168 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8169 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8170 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
8171 case.
8172
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008173 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8174 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8175
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008176 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8177 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
8178 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
8179 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8180
8181 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8182 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8183
8184 Example :
8185 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
8186 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
8187 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8188 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8189
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008190 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8191 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008192
8193
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008194reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8195reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008196 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
8197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8198 no | yes | yes | yes
8199 Arguments :
8200 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8201 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8202 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8203 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8204 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
8205 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
8206
8207 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8208 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8209 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8210 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008211 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008212
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008213 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8214 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8215
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008216 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
8217 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
8218 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
8219
8220 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8221 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8222 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8223 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
8224 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8225
8226 Example :
8227 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008228 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008229 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
8230 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
8231
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008232 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
8233 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008234
8235
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008236reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8237reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008238 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
8239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8240 no | yes | yes | yes
8241 Arguments :
8242 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8243 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8244 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8245 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8246 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8247 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
8248 ignores case.
8249
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008250 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8251 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8252
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008253 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8254 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008255 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
8256 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
8257 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008258 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
8259 not set.
8260
8261 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
8262 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
8263 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
8264 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
8265 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
8266
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008267 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008268 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008269 # block all others.
8270 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
8271 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
8272
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008273 # block bad guys
8274 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
8275 reqitarpit . if badguys
8276
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008277 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
8278 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008279
8280
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008281retries <value>
8282 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8283 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8284 yes | no | yes | yes
8285 Arguments :
8286 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8287 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8288 default value is 3.
8289
8290 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8291 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8292 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8293
8294 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008295 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8296 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008297
8298 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8299 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8300
8301 See also : "option redispatch"
8302
8303
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008304retry-on [list of keywords]
8305 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8306 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8307 yes | no | yes | yes
8308 Arguments :
8309 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8310 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8311 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8312 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8313
8314 none never retry
8315
8316 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8317 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8318
8319 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8320 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8321 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8322 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8323 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8324 processing the request.
8325
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008326 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8327 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8328 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8329 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8330 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8331 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8332 overflow attack for example).
8333
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008334 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8335 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8336 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8337 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8338 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8339 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8340 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8341 amplify denial of service attacks.
8342
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008343 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8344 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8345 considered to be safe to retry.
8346
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008347 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8348 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8349 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8350 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8351
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008352 all-retryable-errors
8353 retry request for any error that are considered
8354 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8355 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8356 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8357
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008358 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8359 not cumulative.
8360
8361 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8362 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8363 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8364 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8365
8366 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8367 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8368 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8369 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8370 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8371 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8372 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8373 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8374 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8375 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8376 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8377 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8378
8379 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8380 should not use this directive.
8381
8382 The default is "conn-failure".
8383
8384 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8385
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008386rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008387 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8389 no | yes | yes | yes
8390 Arguments :
8391 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8392 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008393 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008394
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008395 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8396 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8397
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008398 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8399 the last header of an HTTP response.
8400
8401 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8402 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8403 responses.
8404
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008405 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8406 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008407
8408
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008409rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8410rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008411 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8413 no | yes | yes | yes
8414 Arguments :
8415 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8416 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8417 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8418 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8419 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8420 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8421 ignores case.
8422
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008423 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8424 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8425
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008426 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8427 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008428 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008429 client.
8430
8431 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8432 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8433 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8434
8435 Example :
8436 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008437 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008438
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008439 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8440 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008441
8442
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008443rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8444rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008445 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8447 no | yes | yes | yes
8448 Arguments :
8449 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8450 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8451 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8452 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8453 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8454 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8455 ignores case.
8456
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008457 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8458 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8459
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008460 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8461 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8462 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8463 case-sensitive.
8464
8465 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008466 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8467 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8468 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008469
8470 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8471 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8472
8473 Example :
8474 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8475 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8476
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008477 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8478 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008479
8480
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008481rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8482rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008483 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8485 no | yes | yes | yes
8486 Arguments :
8487 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8488 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8489 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8490 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8491 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8492 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8493 ignores case.
8494
8495 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8496 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8497 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8498 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008499 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008500
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008501 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8502 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8503
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008504 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8505 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8506 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8507
8508 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8509 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8510 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8511 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8512 are not case-sensitive.
8513
8514 Example :
8515 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8516 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8517
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008518 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8519 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008520
8521
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008522server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008523 Declare a server in a backend
8524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8525 no | no | yes | yes
8526 Arguments :
8527 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008528 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008529 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008530
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008531 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8532 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8533 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8534 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008535 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8536 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8537 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8538 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8539 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008540 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8541 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8542 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8543 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8544 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8545 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8546 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008547 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008548 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8549 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8550 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8551 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8552 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8553 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008554 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8555 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008556 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8557 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008558
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008559 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008560 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8561 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8562 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8563 adding this value to the client's port.
8564
8565 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8566 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008567 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008568
8569 Examples :
8570 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8571 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008572 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008573 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8574 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8575 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008576
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008577 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8578 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8579 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8580 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8581 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8582
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008583 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8584 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008585
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008586server-state-file-name [<file>]
8587 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8588 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8589 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8590 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8591 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8592 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8593
8594 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8595 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8596
8597 global
8598 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8599
Willy Tarreau750bb0c2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008600 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008601 load-server-state-from-file
8602
8603 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8604 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008605
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008606server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8607 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8608 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8610 no | no | yes | yes
8611
8612 Arguments:
8613 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8614
8615 <num | range>
8616 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8617 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8618 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8619 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8620
8621 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8622
8623 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8624
8625 <params*>
8626 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8627 keyword.
8628
8629 Examples:
8630 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8631 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8632 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8633
8634 # or
8635 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8636
8637 # would be equivalent to:
8638 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8639 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8640 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8641
8642
8643
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008644source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008645source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008646source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008647 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8649 yes | no | yes | yes
8650 Arguments :
8651 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8652 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008653
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008654 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008655 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8656 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8657 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8658 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8659 supported prefixes are :
8660 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8661 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8662 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008663 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008664 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8665 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008666
8667 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8668 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008669 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8670 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8671 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008672
8673 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8674 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8675 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8676 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8677 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8678 <addr>.
8679
8680 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8681 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8682 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8683 port.
8684
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008685 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8686 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8687 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8688 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008689 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008690 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8691 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8692 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8693 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8694 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8695 HTTP header.
8696
8697 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8698 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008699 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008700 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8701 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8702 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8703 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8704 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8705 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8706 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8707
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008708 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8709 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8710 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8711 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8712 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8713 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8714
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008715 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8716 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8717 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8718 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8719
8720 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8721 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8722 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8723 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8724 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8725 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8726
8727 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8728 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8729 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8730 there are two methods :
8731
8732 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8733 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8734 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8735 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8736 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8737 of the client ranges may be used.
8738
8739 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8740 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8741 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8742 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8743 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8744 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8745 same session.
8746
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008747 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8748 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8749 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008750 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008751
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008752 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8753
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008754 Examples :
8755 backend private
8756 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8757 source 192.168.1.200
8758
8759 backend transparent_ssl1
8760 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8761 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8762
8763 backend transparent_ssl2
8764 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8765 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8766 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8767
8768 backend transparent_ssl3
8769 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8770 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8771 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8772
8773 backend transparent_smtp
8774 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8775 # with Tproxy version 4.
8776 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8777
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008778 backend transparent_http
8779 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8780 # proxy.
8781 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8782
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008783 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008784 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8785
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008786
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008787srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8788 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8790 yes | no | yes | yes
8791 Arguments :
8792 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8793 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8794 as explained at the top of this document.
8795
8796 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8797 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8798 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8799 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8800 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8801 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8802 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8803
8804 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8805 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8806 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8807 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8808 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008809 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008810 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008811 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008812
8813 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8814 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8815 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8816 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8817 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8818 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8819
8820 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8821 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8822
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008823 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8824 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008825
8826
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008827stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8828 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008830 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008831
8832 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8833 matched.
8834
8835 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8836 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8837
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008838 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8839 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008840 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008841
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008842 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8843 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8844 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8845 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008846
8847 Example :
8848 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8849 backend stats_localhost
8850 stats enable
8851 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8852
8853 Example :
8854 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8855 backend stats_auth
8856 stats enable
8857 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8858 stats admin if TRUE
8859
8860 Example :
8861 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8862 userlist stats-auth
8863 group admin users admin
8864 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8865 group readonly users haproxy
8866 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8867
8868 backend stats_auth
8869 stats enable
8870 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8871 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8872 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8873 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8874
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008875 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8876 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8877 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008878
8879
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008880stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8881 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008883 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008884 Arguments :
8885 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8886
8887 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8888
8889 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8890 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8891 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8892 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8893 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8894 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8895
8896 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8897 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8898 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008899 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008900
8901 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8902 report using "stats scope".
8903
8904 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8905 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8906 unobvious parameters.
8907
8908 Example :
8909 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8910 backend public_www
8911 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8912 stats enable
8913 stats hide-version
8914 stats scope .
8915 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008916 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008917 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8918 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8919
8920 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8921 backend private_monitoring
8922 stats enable
8923 stats uri /admin?stats
8924 stats refresh 5s
8925
8926 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8927
8928
8929stats enable
8930 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008932 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008933 Arguments : none
8934
8935 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8936 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8937 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8938 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8939 - stats auth : no authentication
8940 - stats scope : no restriction
8941
8942 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8943 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8944 unobvious parameters.
8945
8946 Example :
8947 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8948 backend public_www
8949 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8950 stats enable
8951 stats hide-version
8952 stats scope .
8953 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008954 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008955 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8956 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8957
8958 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8959 backend private_monitoring
8960 stats enable
8961 stats uri /admin?stats
8962 stats refresh 5s
8963
8964 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8965
8966
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008967stats hide-version
8968 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008970 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008971 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008972
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008973 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8974 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8975 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8976 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8977 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8978 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008980 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8981 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8982 unobvious parameters.
8983
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008984 Example :
8985 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8986 backend public_www
8987 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008988 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008989 stats hide-version
8990 stats scope .
8991 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008992 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008993 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8994 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008995
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008996 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8997 backend private_monitoring
8998 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008999 stats uri /admin?stats
9000 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009001
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009002 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009003
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009004
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009005stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9006 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9007 Access control for statistics
9008
9009 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9010 no | no | yes | yes
9011
9012 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9013 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9014 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9015 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9016 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9017 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9018
9019 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9020 instance.
9021
9022 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9023 about ACL usage.
9024
9025
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009026stats realm <realm>
9027 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009029 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009030 Arguments :
9031 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9032 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9033 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9034
9035 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9036 using a backslash ('\').
9037
9038 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9039 only related to authentication.
9040
9041 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9042 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9043 unobvious parameters.
9044
9045 Example :
9046 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9047 backend public_www
9048 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9049 stats enable
9050 stats hide-version
9051 stats scope .
9052 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009053 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009054 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9055 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9056
9057 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9058 backend private_monitoring
9059 stats enable
9060 stats uri /admin?stats
9061 stats refresh 5s
9062
9063 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9064
9065
9066stats refresh <delay>
9067 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009069 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009070 Arguments :
9071 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9072 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9073 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9074 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9075 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9076 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9077
9078 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9079 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9080 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9081 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9082
9083 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9084 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9085 unobvious parameters.
9086
9087 Example :
9088 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9089 backend public_www
9090 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9091 stats enable
9092 stats hide-version
9093 stats scope .
9094 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009095 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009096 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9097 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9098
9099 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9100 backend private_monitoring
9101 stats enable
9102 stats uri /admin?stats
9103 stats refresh 5s
9104
9105 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9106
9107
9108stats scope { <name> | "." }
9109 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009111 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009112 Arguments :
9113 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9114 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9115 section in which the statement appears.
9116
9117 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9118 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9119 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9120 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9121 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9122 exists.
9123
9124 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9125 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9126 unobvious parameters.
9127
9128 Example :
9129 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9130 backend public_www
9131 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9132 stats enable
9133 stats hide-version
9134 stats scope .
9135 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009136 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009137 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9138 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9139
9140 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9141 backend private_monitoring
9142 stats enable
9143 stats uri /admin?stats
9144 stats refresh 5s
9145
9146 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9147
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009148
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009149stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009150 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009152 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009153
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009154 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009155 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9156
9157 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9158 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9159
9160 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9161 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009162 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009163
9164 Example :
9165 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9166 backend private_monitoring
9167 stats enable
9168 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9169 stats uri /admin?stats
9170 stats refresh 5s
9171
9172 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9173 global section.
9174
9175
9176stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009177 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9179 yes | yes | yes | yes
9180 Arguments : none
9181
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009182 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009183 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9184 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9185 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9186 - IP (socket, server)
9187 - cookie (backend, server)
9188
9189 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9190 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009191 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009192
9193 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9194
9195
9196stats show-node [ <name> ]
9197 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009199 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009200 Arguments:
9201 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9202 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9203
9204 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9205 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009206 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009207
9208 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9209 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9210 unobvious parameters.
9211
9212 Example:
9213 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9214 backend private_monitoring
9215 stats enable
9216 stats show-node Europe-1
9217 stats uri /admin?stats
9218 stats refresh 5s
9219
9220 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9221 section.
9222
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009223
9224stats uri <prefix>
9225 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009227 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009228 Arguments :
9229 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9230 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9231 query string.
9232
9233 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9234 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9235 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9236 possible to reach it in the application.
9237
9238 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009239 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009240 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9241 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9242 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9243 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9244
9245 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9246 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9247 an address or a port to statistics only.
9248
9249 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9250 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9251 unobvious parameters.
9252
9253 Example :
9254 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9255 backend public_www
9256 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9257 stats enable
9258 stats hide-version
9259 stats scope .
9260 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009261 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009262 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9263 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9264
9265 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9266 backend private_monitoring
9267 stats enable
9268 stats uri /admin?stats
9269 stats refresh 5s
9270
9271 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9272
9273
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009274stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9275 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009277 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009278
9279 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009280 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009281 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009282 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009283 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9284
9285 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9286 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9287 the "stick-table" statement.
9288
9289 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9290 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9291 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9292 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9293 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9294
9295 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9296 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9297 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9298 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9299 transformation rules.
9300
9301 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9302 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9303 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9304 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9305 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9306 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9307 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9308
9309 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9310 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9311 ACL based conditions.
9312
9313 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9314 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9315 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9316 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9317
9318 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9319 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9320 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9321 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9322
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009323 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9324 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009325 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009326
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009327 Example :
9328 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9329 # last 30 minutes
9330 backend pop
9331 mode tcp
9332 balance roundrobin
9333 stick store-request src
9334 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9335 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9336 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9337
9338 backend smtp
9339 mode tcp
9340 balance roundrobin
9341 stick match src table pop
9342 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9343 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9344
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009345 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009346 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009347
9348
9349stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9350 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9352 no | no | yes | yes
9353
9354 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9355 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9356 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9357 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9358
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009359 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9360 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009361 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009362
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009363 Examples :
9364 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009365 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009366
9367 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9368 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9369 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9370
9371
9372 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9373 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9374 backend http
9375 mode http
9376 balance roundrobin
9377 stick on src table https
9378 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9379 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9380 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9381
9382 backend https
9383 mode tcp
9384 balance roundrobin
9385 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9386 stick on src
9387 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9388 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9389
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009390 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009391
9392
9393stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9394 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9396 no | no | yes | yes
9397
9398 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009399 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009400 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009401 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009402 server is selected.
9403
9404 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9405 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9406 the "stick-table" statement.
9407
9408 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9409 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9410 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9411 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9412 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9413 address.
9414
9415 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9416 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9417 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9418 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9419 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9420 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9421 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9422 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9423 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9424 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9425
9426 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9427 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9428 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9429 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9430 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9431 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9432 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9433
9434 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9435 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9436 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9437 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9438
9439 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9440 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9441 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9442 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9443 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9444 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009445 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9446 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9447 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9448 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9449 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9450 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009451
9452 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9453 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9454 the request.
9455
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009456 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9457 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009458 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009459
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009460 Example :
9461 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9462 # last 30 minutes
9463 backend pop
9464 mode tcp
9465 balance roundrobin
9466 stick store-request src
9467 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9468 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9469 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9470
9471 backend smtp
9472 mode tcp
9473 balance roundrobin
9474 stick match src table pop
9475 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9476 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9477
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009478 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009479 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009480
9481
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009482stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009483 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9484 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009485 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009487 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009488
9489 Arguments :
9490 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9491 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9492 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9493 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9494
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009495 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9496 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9497 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9498 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9499
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009500 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9501 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9502 instance.
9503
9504 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9505 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9506 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9507 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9508 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9509 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009510 to 32 characters.
9511
9512 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9513 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9514 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009515 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009516 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9517 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009518
9519 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009520 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9521 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009522 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9523 increase.
9524
9525 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009526 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9527 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9528 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009529
9530 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9531 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9532 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9533 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009534 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009535 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9536 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9537 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9538 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9539 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9540 parameter (see below).
9541
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009542 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9543 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9544 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9545 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9546 soft restart.
9547
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009548 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9549 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009550
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009551 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9552 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9553 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9554 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009555 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009556 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009557 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9558 if not expiration delay is specified.
9559
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009560 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9561 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9562 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9563 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009564 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9565 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9566 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9567 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9568 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9569 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9570 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9571 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9572 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9573 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9574 types and their arguments.
9575
9576 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9577 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9578 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9579 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9580
9581 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9582 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9583 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009584 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009585
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009586 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9587 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9588 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009589 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009590 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009591 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009592
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009593 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9594 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9595 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9596 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9597
9598 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9599 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9600 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9601 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9602 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9603 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9604
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009605 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9606 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9607 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9608 they were received.
9609
9610 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9611 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9612 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9613 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9614 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9615
9616 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9617 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9618 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9619 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9620 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9621
9622 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9623 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9624 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9625
9626 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9627 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9628 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9629 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9630 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9631
9632 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9633 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9634 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9635 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9636 the client side.
9637
9638 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9639 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9640 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9641 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9642 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9643 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9644 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9645
9646 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9647 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9648 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9649 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9650 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9651 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009652 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009653
9654 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9655 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9656 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9657 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9658 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9659 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9660
9661 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009662 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009663 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9664 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9665
9666 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9667 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9668 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9669 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9670 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9671 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9672 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9673 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9674 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9675 recommended for better fairness.
9676
9677 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009678 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009679 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9680 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9681
9682 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9683 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9684 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9685 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9686 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9687 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9688 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9689 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9690 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9691 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009692
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009693 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9694 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009695 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9696 reference it.
9697
9698 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9699 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009700 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9701 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9702 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009703
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009704 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9705 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9706 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9707 something that can be ignored.
9708
9709 Example:
9710 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9711 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9712 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9713 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9714
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009715 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009716 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009717
9718
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009719stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009720 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9722 no | no | yes | yes
9723
9724 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009725 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009726 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009727 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009728 server is selected.
9729
9730 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9731 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9732 the "stick-table" statement.
9733
9734 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9735 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9736 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9737 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9738
9739 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9740 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9741 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9742 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9743 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9744 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009745 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009746 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9747 rules.
9748
9749 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9750 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9751 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9752 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9753 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9754 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9755 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9756
9757 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9758 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9759 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9760 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9761
9762 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9763 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9764 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9765 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9766 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9767 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009768 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9769 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9770 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9771 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9772 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9773 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9774 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9775 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9776 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009777
9778 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9779
9780 Example :
9781 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9782 backend https
9783 mode tcp
9784 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009785 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009786 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009787
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009788 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9789 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9790
9791 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9792 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9793 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9794
9795 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9796 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009797
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009798 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9799 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9800 # at offset 44.
9801
9802 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9803 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9804
9805 # Learn on response if server hello.
9806 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009807
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009808 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9809 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9810
9811 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9812 extraction.
9813
9814
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009815tcp-check connect [params*]
9816 Opens a new connection
9817 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9818 no | no | yes | yes
9819
9820 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9821 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9822 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9823
9824 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9825 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9826 of the sequence.
9827
9828 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9829 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9830 do.
9831
9832 Parameters :
9833 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9834 use the TCP connection.
9835
9836 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9837 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9838 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9839
9840 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9841
9842 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9843
9844 Examples:
9845 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9846 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9847 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9848 option tcp-check
9849 tcp-check connect
9850 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9851 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9852 tcp-check send \r\n
9853 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9854 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9855 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9856 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9857 tcp-check send \r\n
9858 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9859 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9860
9861 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9862 option tcp-check
9863 tcp-check connect port 110
9864 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9865 tcp-check connect port 143
9866 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9867 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9868
9869 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9870
9871
9872tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009873 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009874 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9875 no | no | yes | yes
9876
9877 Arguments :
9878 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9879 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9880 binary.
9881 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9882 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9883 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9884
9885 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9886 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9887 with the usual backslash ('\').
9888 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009889 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009890 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9891 used upper or lower case.
9892
9893
9894 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9895
9896 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9897 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9898 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9899 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9900 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9901 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9902 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9903 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9904
9905 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9906 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9907 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9908 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9909 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9910 expression.
9911
9912 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9913 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9914 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9915 this exact hexadecimal string.
9916 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9917
9918 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9919 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9920 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9921 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9922 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9923 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9924 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9925 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9926 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9927 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9928 the null character.
9929
9930 Examples :
9931 # perform a POP check
9932 option tcp-check
9933 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9934
9935 # perform an IMAP check
9936 option tcp-check
9937 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9938
9939 # look for the redis master server
9940 option tcp-check
9941 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009942 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009943 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9944 tcp-check expect string role:master
9945 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9946 tcp-check expect string +OK
9947
9948
9949 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9950 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9951
9952
9953tcp-check send <data>
9954 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9955 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9956 no | no | yes | yes
9957
9958 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9959 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9960
9961 Examples :
9962 # look for the redis master server
9963 option tcp-check
9964 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9965 tcp-check expect string role:master
9966
9967 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9968 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9969
9970
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009971tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9972 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009973 tcp health check
9974 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9975 no | no | yes | yes
9976
9977 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9978 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009979 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009980 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9981 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9982 hexadecimal string.
9983 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9984
9985 Examples :
9986 # redis check in binary
9987 option tcp-check
9988 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9989 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9990
9991
9992 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9993 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9994
9995
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009996tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9997 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9999 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010000 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010001 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10002 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010003
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010004 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010005
10006 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10007 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010008 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10009 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10010 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10011 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10012 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10013 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010014
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010015 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10016 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10017 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10018 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010019
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010020 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010021 - accept :
10022 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10023 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10024 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010025
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010026 - reject :
10027 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10028 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10029 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10030 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10031 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10032 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10033 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10034 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10035 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10036 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10037 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010038 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010039
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010040 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10041 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10042 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10043 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10044 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10045 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10046 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10047 hosts.
10048
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010049 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10050 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10051 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10052 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10053 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10054 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10055 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10056 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10057
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010058 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10059 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10060 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10061 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10062 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10063 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10064 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10065 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10066 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010067 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10068 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010069
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010070 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010071 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010072 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10073 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10074 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010075 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010076 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10077 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10078 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10079 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10080 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10081 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10082 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10083 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010084
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010085 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010086 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010087 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010088 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010089 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10090 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10091 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010092
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010093 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10094 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10095 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10096 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010097
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010098 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10099 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10100 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10101 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10102 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010103 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10104 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10105 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10106 layer7 information is extracted.
10107
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010108 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10109 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10110 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10111 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10112 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010113
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010114 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10115 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10116 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10117 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10118
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010119 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10120 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10121 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10122 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10123
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010124 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
10125 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10126 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10127 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10128 continues.
10129
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010130 - set-src <expr> :
10131 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10132 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10133 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010134 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010135
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010136 Arguments:
10137 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10138 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010139
10140 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010141 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10142
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010143 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10144 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010145
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010146 - set-src-port <expr> :
10147 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10148 expression.
10149
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010150 Arguments:
10151 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10152 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010153
10154 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010155 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10156
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010157 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10158 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10159 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010160
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010161 - set-dst <expr> :
10162 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10163 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10164 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10165 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10166 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10167
10168 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10169 followed by some converters.
10170
10171 Example:
10172
10173 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10174 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10175
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010176 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10177 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10178
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010179 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10180 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10181 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10182 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10183
10184
10185 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10186 followed by some converters.
10187
10188 Example:
10189
10190 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10191
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010192 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10193 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10194 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10195
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010196 - "silent-drop" :
10197 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010198 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010199 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10200 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10201 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10202 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10203 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010204 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10205 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010206 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10207 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010208 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010209 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10210 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10211 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10212 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10213
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010214 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10215 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10216 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010217
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010218 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10219 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10220 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010221
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010222 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010223 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010224 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010225
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010226 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10227 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10228 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010229
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010230 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010231 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10232 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010233
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010234 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10235
10236 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10237
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010238 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10239
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010240 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010241
10242
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010243tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10244 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010246 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010247 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010248 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10249 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010250
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010251 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010252
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010253 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010254 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10255 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10256 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10257 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010258
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010259 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10260 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10261 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10262 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010263 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10264 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10265 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10266 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10267 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10268 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010269 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010270 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010271
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010272 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10273 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10274 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10275 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010276
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010277 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010278 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010279 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010280 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10281 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010282 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010283 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010284 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010285 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +020010286 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010287 - set-dst <expr>
10288 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010289 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010290 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010291 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010292 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010293 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010294
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010295 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10296 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010297 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10298 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010299
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010300 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10301 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10302 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10303 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10304 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10305 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010306
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010307 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010308 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10309 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010310
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010311 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010312 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10313 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10314 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10315 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010316 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10317 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10318 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010319
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010320 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010321 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10322 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10323 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010324
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010325 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10326 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10327
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010328 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010329 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10330 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010331
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010332 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10333 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010334 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010335 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10336 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010337 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010338 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010339 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010340 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10341 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010342 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010343 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10344 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010345
10346 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10347 followed by some converters.
10348
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010349 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10350 <var-name>.
10351
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010352 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10353 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10354 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10355 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10356 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10357
10358 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10359 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10360 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10361 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10362 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10363 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10364 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10365 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10366 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10367 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10368 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10369
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010370 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10371 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10372 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10373 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10374 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10375
10376 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10377
10378 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10379
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010380 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10381 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10382 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10383 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10384 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10385 evaluated.
10386
10387 Example:
10388 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10389
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010390 Example:
10391
10392 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010393 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010394
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010395 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010396 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10397 # and reject everything else.
10398 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10399 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010400 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010401 tcp-request content reject
10402
10403 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010404 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10405 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10406 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010407 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010408
10409 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10410 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10411 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010412 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010413 tcp-request content reject
10414
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010415 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010416 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010417 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010418 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010419 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10420 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010421
10422 Example:
10423 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10424 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010425 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010426
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010427 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010428 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010429
10430 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010431 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010432 # protecting all our sites
10433 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010434 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10435 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010436 ...
10437 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10438
10439 backend http_dynamic
10440 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010441 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010442 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010443 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010444 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010445 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010446 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010447
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010448 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010449
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010450 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10451 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010452
10453
10454tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10455 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010457 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010458 Arguments :
10459 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10460 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10461 as explained at the top of this document.
10462
10463 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10464 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10465 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10466 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10467 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10468
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010469 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10470 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10471 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10472 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10473
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010474 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10475 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010476 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010477 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010478 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10479 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10480 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10481 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010482
10483 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10484 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10485 it pass through unaffected.
10486
10487 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10488 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10489 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010490 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010491 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10492 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010493 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10494 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10495 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010496
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010497 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010498 "timeout client".
10499
10500
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010501tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10502 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10504 no | no | yes | yes
10505 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010506 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10507 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010508
10509 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10510
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010511 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010512 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10513 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010514 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10515 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010516
10517 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10518
10519 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10520 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10521 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10522 inserted.
10523
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010524 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010525 - accept :
10526 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10527 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10528 the rules evaluation.
10529
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010530 - close :
10531 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10532 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10533 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10534 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10535 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10536 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010537 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010538 protocols.
10539
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010540 - reject :
10541 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10542 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010543 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010544
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010545 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10546 Sets a variable.
10547
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010548 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10549 Unsets a variable.
10550
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010551 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10552 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10553 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10554 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10555
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010556 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10557 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10558 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10559 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10560
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010561 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10562 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10563 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10564 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10565 continues.
10566
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010567 - "silent-drop" :
10568 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010569 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010570 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10571 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10572 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10573 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10574 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010575 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10576 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010577 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10578 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010579 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010580 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10581 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10582 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10583 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10584
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010585 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10586 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10587
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010588 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10589 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10590 for changing the default action to a reject.
10591
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010592 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10593 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10594 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10595 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010596 period.
10597
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010598 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10599 declared inline.
10600
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010601 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10602 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010603 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010604 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10605 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010606 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010607 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010608 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010609 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10610 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010611 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010612 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10613 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010614
10615 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10616 followed by some converters.
10617
10618 Example:
10619
10620 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10621
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010622 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10623 <var-name>.
10624
10625 Example:
10626
10627 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10628
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010629 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10630 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10631 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10632 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10633 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10634
10635 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10636
10637 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10638
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010639 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10640
10641 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10642
10643
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010644tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10645 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10647 no | yes | yes | no
10648 Arguments :
10649 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10650 below.
10651
10652 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10653
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010654 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010655 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10656 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10657 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10658 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10659 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10660 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10661 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010662 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010663 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10664 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10665 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10666 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10667 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10668 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10669 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10670 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10671 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10672 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10673 instead.
10674
10675 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10676 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10677 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10678 rules which may be inserted.
10679
10680 Several types of actions are supported :
10681 - accept : the request is accepted
10682 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10683 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10684 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010685 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010686 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10687 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010688 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010689 - silent-drop
10690
10691 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10692 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10693 sections for a complete description.
10694
10695 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10696 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10697 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10698
10699 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10700 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10701 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10702 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10703 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10704
10705 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10706 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10707
10708 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10709 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10710 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10711
10712 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10713 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10714 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10715
10716 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10717 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10718 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10719
10720 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10721 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10722 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10723
10724 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10725
10726 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10727
10728
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010729tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10730 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10732 no | no | yes | yes
10733 Arguments :
10734 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10735 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10736 as explained at the top of this document.
10737
10738 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10739
10740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010741timeout check <timeout>
10742 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10743 established.
10744
10745 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10746 yes | no | yes | yes
10747 Arguments:
10748 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10749 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10750 as explained at the top of this document.
10751
10752 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10753 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010754 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010755 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010756 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10757 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10758 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010759
10760 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10761 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10762
10763 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10764 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010765 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010766
10767 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10768 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10769 forget about it.
10770
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010771 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10772 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010773
10774
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010775timeout client <timeout>
10776timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10777 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10779 yes | yes | yes | no
10780 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010781 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010782 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10783 as explained at the top of this document.
10784
10785 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10786 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10787 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010788 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10789 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10790 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10791 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010792 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10793 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10794 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010795 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010796 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010797 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10798 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010799 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10800 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010801
10802 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10803 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10804 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10805 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010806 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010807 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10808
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010809 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010810
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010811 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10812 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10813 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10814
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010815 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10816 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010817
10818
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010819timeout client-fin <timeout>
10820 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10822 yes | yes | yes | no
10823 Arguments :
10824 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10825 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10826 as explained at the top of this document.
10827
10828 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10829 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10830 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10831 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10832 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10833 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10834 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010835 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10836 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10837 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010838
10839 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10840 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10841 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10842
10843 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10844
10845
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010846timeout connect <timeout>
10847timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10848 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10850 yes | no | yes | yes
10851 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010852 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010853 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10854 as explained at the top of this document.
10855
10856 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010857 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010858 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010859 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010860 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10861 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010862
10863 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10864 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10865 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10866 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010867 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010868 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10869
10870 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10871 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10872 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10873
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010874 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10875 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010876
10877
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010878timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10879 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10881 yes | yes | yes | yes
10882 Arguments :
10883 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10884 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10885 as explained at the top of this document.
10886
10887 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10888 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10889 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10890 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10891 once the request has started to present itself.
10892
10893 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10894 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10895 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10896 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10897 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10898
10899 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10900 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10901 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10902 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10903
10904 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10905 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010906 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010907 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10908 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010909 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010910
10911 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10912 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10913 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10914 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10915
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010916 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10917 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010918 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10919
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010920 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10921
10922
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010923timeout http-request <timeout>
10924 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010926 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010927 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010928 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010929 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10930 as explained at the top of this document.
10931
10932 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10933 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10934 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10935 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10936 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10937 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10938 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010939 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10940 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10941 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10942 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010943 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010944 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10945 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010946
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010947 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10948 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10949 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10950 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10951 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010952 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010953
10954 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10955 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010956 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010957 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10958 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10959
10960 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010961 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10962 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10963 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010964
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010965 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010966 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010967
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010968
10969timeout queue <timeout>
10970 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10972 yes | no | yes | yes
10973 Arguments :
10974 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10975 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10976 as explained at the top of this document.
10977
10978 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10979 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10980 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10981 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10982 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10983
10984 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10985 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10986 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10987 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10988
10989 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10990
10991
10992timeout server <timeout>
10993timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10994 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10996 yes | no | yes | yes
10997 Arguments :
10998 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10999 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11000 as explained at the top of this document.
11001
11002 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11003 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11004 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11005 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11006 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11007 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11008 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11009
11010 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11011 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11012 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11013 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11014 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011015 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011016 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011017 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11018 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011019 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11020 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011021
11022 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11023 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11024 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11025 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011026 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011027 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11028
11029 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
11030 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
11031 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
11032
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011033 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011034
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011035
11036timeout server-fin <timeout>
11037 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11039 yes | no | yes | yes
11040 Arguments :
11041 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11042 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11043 as explained at the top of this document.
11044
11045 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11046 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11047 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11048 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11049 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11050 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11051 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11052 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11053 situations, it should not be needed.
11054
11055 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11056 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11057 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11058
11059 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11060
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011061
11062timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011063 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11065 yes | yes | yes | yes
11066 Arguments :
11067 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11068 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11069 as explained at the top of this document.
11070
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011071 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
11072 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
11073 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
11074 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011075
11076 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11077 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11078 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11079 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011080 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011081
11082 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
11083
11084
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011085timeout tunnel <timeout>
11086 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11088 yes | no | yes | yes
11089 Arguments :
11090 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11091 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11092 as explained at the top of this document.
11093
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011094 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011095 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11096 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11097 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011098 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11099 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011100 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11101 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11102 specified.
11103
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011104 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11105 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11106 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11107 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11108 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11109 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11110 state.
11111
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011112 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11113 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11114 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11115 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011116 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011117
11118 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11119 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11120 forget about it.
11121
11122 Example :
11123 defaults http
11124 option http-server-close
11125 timeout connect 5s
11126 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011127 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011128 timeout server 30s
11129 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11130
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011131 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011132
11133
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011134transparent (deprecated)
11135 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011137 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011138 Arguments : none
11139
11140 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11141 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11142 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11143 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11144 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11145 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11146 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11147 appropriate server.
11148
11149 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11150
11151 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11152 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11153
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011154 See also: "option transparent"
11155
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011156unique-id-format <string>
11157 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11159 yes | yes | yes | no
11160 Arguments :
11161 <string> is a log-format string.
11162
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011163 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11164 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11165 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11166 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011167
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011168 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11169 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11170 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11171 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11172 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11173 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11174 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11175 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011176
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011177 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11178 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011179
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011180 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011181
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011182 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011183
11184 will generate:
11185
11186 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11187
11188 See also: "unique-id-header"
11189
11190unique-id-header <name>
11191 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11193 yes | yes | yes | no
11194 Arguments :
11195 <name> is the name of the header.
11196
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011197 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11198 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011199
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011200 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011201
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011202 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011203 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11204
11205 will generate:
11206
11207 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11208
11209 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011210
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011211use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011212 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11214 no | yes | yes | no
11215 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011216 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11217 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011218
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011219 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11220 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011221
11222 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11223 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11224 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011225 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011226 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011227 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11228 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011229
11230 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11231 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11232 assign the backend.
11233
11234 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11235 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11236 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11237 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11238 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11239 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11240
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011241 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011242 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011243 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11244 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11245 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11246
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011247 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11248 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11249 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11250 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11251 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11252 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11253 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11254 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11255 cannot be forced from the request.
11256
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011257 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011258 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11259 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11260
11261 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11262 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011263
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011264
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011265use-server <server> if <condition>
11266use-server <server> unless <condition>
11267 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11269 no | no | yes | yes
11270 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011271 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011272
11273 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11274
11275 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11276 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11277 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11278
11279 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11280 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11281 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11282 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11283 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11284 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11285 matches will assign the server.
11286
11287 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11288 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11289 with the next rules until one matches.
11290
11291 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11292 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11293 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11294 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11295
11296 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11297 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11298 stripped.
11299
11300 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11301 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11302 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11303 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11304
11305 Example :
11306 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11307 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11308 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11309 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11310 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11311 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011312 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011313 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11314 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11315
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011316 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011317
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011318
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100113195. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011320--------------------------
11321
11322The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11323depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11324settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11325written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11326described in this section.
11327
11328
113295.1. Bind options
11330-----------------
11331
11332The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11333as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11334no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11335parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11336while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11337provided immediately after the setting name.
11338
11339The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11340
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011341accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11342 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11343 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11344 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11345 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11346 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11347 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11348 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11349 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11350 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011351 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11352 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11353 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011354
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011355accept-proxy
11356 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011357 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11358 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011359 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11360 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11361 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11362 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011363 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011364 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11365 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011366 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11367 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011368
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011369allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011370 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011371 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011372 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011373 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11374 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011375
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011376alpn <protocols>
11377 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11378 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11379 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011380 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011381 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011382 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11383 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11384 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11385 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11386 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11387 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11388 preference, like below :
11389
11390 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011391
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011392backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011393 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011394 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11395
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011396curves <curves>
11397 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11398 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11399 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11400 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11401 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11402 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11403
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011404ecdhe <named curve>
11405 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011406 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11407 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011408
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011409ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011410 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11411 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11412 client's certificate.
11413
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011414ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11415 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11416 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11417 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11418 error is ignored.
11419
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011420ca-sign-file <cafile>
11421 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11422 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11423 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11424 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11425 'generate-certificates' for details.
11426
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011427ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011428 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11429 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11430 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11431 'generate-certificates' for details.
11432
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011433ciphers <ciphers>
11434 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11435 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011436 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011437 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011438 information and recommendations see e.g.
11439 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11440 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11441 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11442
11443ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11444 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11445 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11446 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11447 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011448 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11449 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011450
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011451crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011452 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11453 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11454 to verify client's certificate.
11455
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011456crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011457 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11458 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11459 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11460 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11461 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11462 file.
11463
11464 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11465 are loaded.
11466
11467 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011468 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011469 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11470 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11471 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11472 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011473 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11474 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011475 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011476
11477 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11478 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11479 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11480 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011481 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11482 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011483
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011484 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011485
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011486 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011487 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011488 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11489 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011490 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11491 clients).
11492
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011493 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11494 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11495 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11496 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11497 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11498 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11499 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11500 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11501 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11502 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11503 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11504 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11505 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11506
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011507 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11508 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11509 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11510 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11511 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11512
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011513 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11514 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11515 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11516 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011517
11518 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11519 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11520 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11521 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11522 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11523 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11524 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11525 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11526 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11527
11528 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11529
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011530 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011531 a cert bundle.
11532
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011533 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011534 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11535 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11536 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11537 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11538 provide multi-cert support.
11539
11540 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11541
11542 Filename | CN | SAN
11543 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11544 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011545 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011546 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11547 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11548
11549 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11550 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11551 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11552 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011553 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11554 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11555 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011556
11557 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11558 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11559
11560 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11561 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11562 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11563
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011564crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011565 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011566 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011567 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011568 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011569
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011570crt-list <file>
11571 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011572 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11573 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011574
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011575 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11576
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011577 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11578 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011579 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011580 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011581
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011582 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11583 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11584 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11585 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11586 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11587 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11588 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11589 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011590
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011591 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011592 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011593 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11594 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11595 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011596
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011597 crt-list file example:
11598 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011599 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011600 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011601 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011602
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011603defer-accept
11604 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11605 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11606 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011607 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011608 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11609 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11610 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11611 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11612 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11613 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11614 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11615
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011616expose-fd listeners
11617 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11618 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011619 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11620 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011621 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011622
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011623force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011624 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011625 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011626 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011627 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011628
11629force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011630 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011631 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011632 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011633
11634force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011635 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011636 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011637 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011638
11639force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011640 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011641 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011642 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011643
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011644force-tlsv13
11645 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11646 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011647 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011648
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011649generate-certificates
11650 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11651 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11652 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11653 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11654 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11655 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11656 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11657 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11658 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11659 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11660 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11661
11662 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11663 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011664 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011665 certificate is used many times.
11666
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011667gid <gid>
11668 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11669 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11670 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11671 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11672 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11673
11674group <group>
11675 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11676 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11677 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11678 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11679 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11680
11681id <id>
11682 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11683 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11684 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11685 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11686
11687interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011688 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11689 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11690 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11691 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11692 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11693 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011694 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11695 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11696 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11697 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11698 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11699 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011700
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011701level <level>
11702 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11703 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11704 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011705 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011706 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11707 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11708 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011709 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011710 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011711 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011712 all counters).
11713
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011714severity-output <format>
11715 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11716 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11717 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11718 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11719 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11720 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11721 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11722 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11723 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11724 rfc5424 convention.
11725
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011726maxconn <maxconn>
11727 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11728 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11729 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11730 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11731 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11732 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11733 eat all memory.
11734
11735mode <mode>
11736 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11737 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11738 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11739 UNIX sockets.
11740
11741mss <maxseg>
11742 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11743 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11744 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11745 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11746 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11747 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11748 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11749 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11750 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11751 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11752 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11753
11754name <name>
11755 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11756 page.
11757
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011758namespace <name>
11759 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11760 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11761 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11762 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11763
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011764nice <nice>
11765 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11766 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11767 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11768 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11769 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11770 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11771 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11772 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11773 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11774 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11775 one for an RDP socket.
11776
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011777no-ca-names
11778 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11779 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11780
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011781no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011782 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011783 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011784 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011785 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011786 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11787 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011788
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011789no-tls-tickets
11790 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11791 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11792 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011793 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11794 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010011795 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
11796 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
11797 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011798
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011799no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011800 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011801 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011802 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011803 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011804 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11805 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011806
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011807no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011808 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011809 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011810 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011811 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011812 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11813 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011814
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011815no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011816 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011817 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011818 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011819 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011820 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11821 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011822
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011823no-tlsv13
11824 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11825 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11826 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11827 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011828 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11829 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011830
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011831npn <protocols>
11832 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11833 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11834 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011835 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011836 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011837 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11838 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11839 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11840 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11841 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011842
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011843prefer-client-ciphers
11844 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11845 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11846 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011847 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11848 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11849 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011850
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011851process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011852 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011853 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011854 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011855 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11856 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11857 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11858 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011859 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011860 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11861 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11862 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11863 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11864 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011865
11866 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11867
11868 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11869 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11870 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11871 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11872 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11873 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11874 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11875 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011876
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011877proto <name>
11878 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11879 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11880 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11881 in haproxy -vv.
11882 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11883 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011884 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011885 h2" on the bind line.
11886
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011887ssl
11888 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011889 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011890 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11891 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011892 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11893 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011894
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011895ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11896 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11897 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11898 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11899
11900ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11901 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11902 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11903 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11904
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011905strict-sni
11906 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11907 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11908 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11909 See the "crt" option for more information.
11910
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011911tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011912 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011913 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11914 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011915 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011916 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11917 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11918 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11919 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11920 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11921 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11922 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11923
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011924tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011925 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011926 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11927 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11928 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11929 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11930 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11931 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11932 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011933 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11934 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11935 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011936
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011937tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11938 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011939 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11940 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11941 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11942 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11943 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11944 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11945 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11946 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11947 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11948 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011949 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11950 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11951
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011952transparent
11953 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11954 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11955 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11956 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11957 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11958 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11959 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11960 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11961 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11962 so check for support with your vendor.
11963
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011964v4v6
11965 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11966 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11967 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11968 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011969 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011970
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011971v6only
11972 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11973 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11974 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011975 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11976 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011977
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011978uid <uid>
11979 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11980 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11981 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11982 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11983 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11984
11985user <user>
11986 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11987 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11988 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11989 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11990 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11991
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011992verify [none|optional|required]
11993 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11994 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11995 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11996 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11997 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011998 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11999 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12000 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12001 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012002
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200120035.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012004------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012005
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012006The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12007which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12008arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12009settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12010after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12011Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12012address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012014 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012015 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012016
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012017Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12018keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012020The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012021
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012022addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012023 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012024 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12025 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12026 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12027 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12028 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012029
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012030agent-check
12031 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012032 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012033 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12034 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12035 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012036
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012037 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012038 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012039 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12040 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12041 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012042
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012043 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12044 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12045 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12046 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12047 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012048
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012049 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012050 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012051
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012052 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12053 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12054 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012055
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012056 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12057 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12058 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012059
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012060 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12061 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12062 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12063 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12064 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012065 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012066 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012067
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012068 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12069 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012070
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012071 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12072 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12073 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12074 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12075 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12076 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12077 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12078 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12079 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012080
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012081 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12082 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012083 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12084 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12085 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012086 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012087
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012088 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012089 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012090
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012091agent-send <string>
12092 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12093 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12094 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12095 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12096 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12097
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012098agent-inter <delay>
12099 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12100 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12101
12102 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12103 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12104 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12105 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12106 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12107 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12108 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12109 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12110 of backends use the same servers.
12111
12112 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12113
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012114agent-addr <addr>
12115 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12116
12117 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12118 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12119 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12120 hostname, it will be resolved.
12121
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012122agent-port <port>
12123 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12124
12125 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12126
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012127allow-0rtt
12128 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012129 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12130 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012131
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012132alpn <protocols>
12133 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12134 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12135 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012136 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012137 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12138 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12139 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12140 now obsolete NPN extension.
12141 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12142 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12143
12144 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12145
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012146backup
12147 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12148 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12149 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12150 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012151 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12152 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012153
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012154ca-file <cafile>
12155 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12156 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12157 server's certificate.
12158
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012159check
12160 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012161 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12162 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12163 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12164 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12165 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12166 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12167 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012168 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12169 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012170 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12171 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012172
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012173check-send-proxy
12174 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12175 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12176 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12177 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12178 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12179 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12180 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12181
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012182check-alpn <protocols>
12183 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12184 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12185 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12186
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012187check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012188 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012189 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12190 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012191
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012192check-ssl
12193 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12194 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12195 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12196 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012197 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012198 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12199 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012200 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012201 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12202 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012203
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012204check-via-socks4
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012205 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012206 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12207 for normal traffic.
12208
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012209ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012210 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12211 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12212 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012213 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12214 information and recommendations see e.g.
12215 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12216 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12217 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012218
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012219ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12220 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12221 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12222 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12223 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012224 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12225 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12226 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012228cookie <value>
12229 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12230 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12231 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12232 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12233 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12234 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12235 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12236
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012237crl-file <crlfile>
12238 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12239 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12240 to verify server's certificate.
12241
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012242crt <cert>
12243 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12244 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12245 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12246 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12247 certificate request.
12248
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012249disabled
12250 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12251 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12252 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12253 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12254 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012255 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012256
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012257enabled
12258 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12259 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12260 default value.
12261 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12262 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012263
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012264error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012265 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12266 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12267 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012268
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012269 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012271fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012272 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12273 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12274 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12275
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012276force-sslv3
12277 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12278 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012279 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012280 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012281
12282force-tlsv10
12283 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012284 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012285 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012286
12287force-tlsv11
12288 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012289 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012290 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012291
12292force-tlsv12
12293 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012294 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012295 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012296
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012297force-tlsv13
12298 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12299 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012300 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012302id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012303 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12304 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12305 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012306
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012307init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12308 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12309 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012310 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012311 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12312 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12313 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12314 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12315 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12316 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12317 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12318 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12319 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012320 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012321 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12322 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12323 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12324 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12325 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12326 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012327 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012328
12329 Example:
12330 defaults
12331 # never fail on address resolution
12332 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12333
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012334inter <delay>
12335fastinter <delay>
12336downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012337 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12338 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12339 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12340 between checks depending on the server state :
12341
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012342 Server state | Interval used
12343 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12344 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12345 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12346 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12347 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12348 or yet unchecked. |
12349 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12350 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12351 | "inter" otherwise.
12352 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012354 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12355 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12356 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12357 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012358 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12359 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12360 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12361 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12362 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012363
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012364maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012365 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12366 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012367 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12368 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012369 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12370 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12371 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12372 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12373
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012374 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12375 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12376 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12377 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12378 than 50 concurrent requests.
12379
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012380maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012381 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12382 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12383 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12384 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12385 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12386 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12387 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12388
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012389max-reuse <count>
12390 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12391 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12392 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12393 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12394 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12395 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12396 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12397 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12398
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012399minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012400 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12401 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12402 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12403 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12404 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12405 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012406 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012407 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012408
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012409namespace <name>
12410 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12411 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12412 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12413 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12414
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012415no-agent-check
12416 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12417 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12418 default value.
12419 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12420 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12421
12422no-backup
12423 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12424 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12425 default value.
12426 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12427 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12428
12429no-check
12430 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12431 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12432 default value.
12433 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12434 "default-server" "check" setting.
12435
12436no-check-ssl
12437 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12438 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12439 default value.
12440 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12441 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12442
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012443no-send-proxy
12444 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12445 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12446 default value.
12447 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12448 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12449
12450no-send-proxy-v2
12451 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12452 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12453 default value.
12454 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12455 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12456
12457no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12458 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12459 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12460 default value.
12461 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12462 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12463
12464no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12465 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12466 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12467 default value.
12468 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12469 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12470
12471no-ssl
12472 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12473 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12474 default value.
12475 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12476 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12477
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012478no-ssl-reuse
12479 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12480 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12481 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12482 and for paranoid users.
12483
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012484no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012485 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12486 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012487 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012488
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012489 Supported in default-server: No
12490
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012491no-tls-tickets
12492 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12493 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12494 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012495 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12496 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012497 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12498 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12499 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012500 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012501
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012502no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012503 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012504 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12505 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012506 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12507 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012508 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012509
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012510 Supported in default-server: No
12511
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012512no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012513 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012514 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12515 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012516 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12517 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012518 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012519
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012520 Supported in default-server: No
12521
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012522no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012523 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012524 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12525 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012526 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12527 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012528 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012529
12530 Supported in default-server: No
12531
12532no-tlsv13
12533 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12534 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12535 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12536 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12537 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012538 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012539
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012540 Supported in default-server: No
12541
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012542no-verifyhost
12543 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12544 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12545 default value.
12546 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12547 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012548
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012549no-tfo
12550 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12551 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12552 default value.
12553 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12554 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12555
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012556non-stick
12557 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12558 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12559 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12560
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012561npn <protocols>
12562 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12563 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12564 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012565 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012566 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12567 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12568 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12569
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012570observe <mode>
12571 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12572 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12573 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12574 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12575 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12576 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012577 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012578
12579 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012581on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012582 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12583 Currently, four modes are available:
12584 - fastinter: force fastinter
12585 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12586 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12587 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12588 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12589
12590 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12591
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012592on-marked-down <action>
12593 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12594 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012595 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12596 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12597 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12598 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12599 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12600 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12601 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12602 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012603
12604 Actions are disabled by default
12605
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012606on-marked-up <action>
12607 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12608 Currently one action is available:
12609 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12610 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12611 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12612 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012613 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12614 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012615 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12616 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12617
12618 Actions are disabled by default
12619
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012620pool-max-conn <max>
12621 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12622 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12623 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12624 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12625 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12626 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12627
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012628pool-purge-delay <delay>
12629 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012630 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012631 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012632
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012633port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012634 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12635 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12636 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12637 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12638 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12639 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12640
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012641proto <name>
12642
12643 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12644 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12645 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12646 reported in haproxy -vv.
12647 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12648 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012650redir <prefix>
12651 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12652 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12653 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12654 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12655 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12656 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12657 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12658 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012659 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012660 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012661 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12662 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12663 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12664 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12665
12666 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12667
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012668rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012669 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12670 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12671 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12672
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012673resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12674 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12675 server.
12676
12677 Available options:
12678
12679 * allow-dup-ip
12680 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12681 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12682 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12683 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12684 For such case, simply enable this option.
12685 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12686
12687 * prevent-dup-ip
12688 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12689 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12690 same fqdn.
12691 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12692
12693 Example:
12694 backend b_myapp
12695 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12696 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12697 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12698
12699 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12700 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12701 it
12702 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12703 different address
12704
12705 Default value: not set
12706
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012707resolve-prefer <family>
12708 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12709 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12710 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12711 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12712
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012713 Default value: ipv6
12714
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012715 Example:
12716
12717 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012718
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012719resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012720 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012721 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012722 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012723 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12724 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012725 configured network, another address is selected.
12726
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012727 Example:
12728
12729 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012730
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012731resolvers <id>
12732 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12733 hostname.
12734
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012735 Example:
12736
12737 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012738
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012739 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012740
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012741send-proxy
12742 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12743 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12744 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12745 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012746 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12747 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12748 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12749 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12750 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12751 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12752 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12753 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12754 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12755 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012756 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12757 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012758
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012759send-proxy-v2
12760 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12761 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12762 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12763 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012764 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12765 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12766 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12767 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012768
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012769proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12770 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12771 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012772 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12773 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012774 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12775 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012776 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012777
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012778send-proxy-v2-ssl
12779 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12780 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12781 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12782 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12783 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12784 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12785 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012786 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12787 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012788
12789send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12790 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12791 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12792 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12793 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12794 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12795 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12796 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12797 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012798 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12799 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012800
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012801slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012802 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12803 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12804 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12805 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12806 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12807 parameters :
12808
12809 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12810 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12811
12812 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12813 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12814 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12815 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12816
12817 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12818 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12819 seen as failed.
12820
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012821sni <expression>
12822 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12823 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12824 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12825 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012826 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12827 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012828 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012829 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12830 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012831
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012832source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012833source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012834source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012835 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12836 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12837 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12838 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12839
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012840 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12841 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12842 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12843 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12844 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12845 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12846 server.
12847
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012848 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12849 specifying the source address without port(s).
12850
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012851ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012852 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12853 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12854 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12855 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12856 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12857 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012858 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12859 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012860
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012861ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12862 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12863 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12864 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12865
12866ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12867 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12868 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12869 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12870
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012871ssl-reuse
12872 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12873 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12874 default value.
12875 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12876 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12877
12878stick
12879 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12880 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12881 default value.
12882 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12883 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012884
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012885socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012886 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012887 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12888 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12889
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012890tcp-ut <delay>
12891 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12892 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12893 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012894 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012895 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12896 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12897 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12898 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12899 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12900 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12901 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12902 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12903 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12904
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012905tfo
12906 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12907 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12908 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12909 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12910 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012911 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012913track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012914 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12915 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12916 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12917 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012918 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12919
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012920tls-tickets
12921 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12922 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12923 default value.
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012924 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12925 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12926 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012927 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke04037d32020-02-13 14:16:16 +010012928 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012929
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012930verify [none|required]
12931 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012932 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012933 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12934 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012935 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012936 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12937 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12938 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12939 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12940 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12941 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12942 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12943 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012944
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012945verifyhost <hostname>
12946 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012947 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12948 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12949 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12950 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12951 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12952 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12953 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12954 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012956weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012957 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12958 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12959 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012960 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12961 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12962 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12963 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12964 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12965 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012966
12967
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129685.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12969-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012970
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012971HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12972using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12973configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012974This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12975can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12976workload.
12977This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12978resolution at run time.
12979Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12980carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12981
12982
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129835.3.1. Global overview
12984----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012985
12986As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12987different steps of the process life:
12988
12989 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12990 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12991 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12992
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012993 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12994 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012995
12996A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12997 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12998 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12999 resolution to know this new IP.
13000
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013001When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013002HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013003SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13004from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13005will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13006will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013007
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013008A few things important to notice:
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013009 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013010 first valid response.
13011
13012 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13013 servers return an error.
13014
13015
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130165.3.2. The resolvers section
13017----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013018
13019This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013020HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13021contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013022
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013023When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13024uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13025is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13026answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13027
13028When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013029used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013030
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013031 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13032 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13033 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013034
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013035 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13036 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013037
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013038 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13039 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13040 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013041
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013042For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13043following scenarios are possible:
13044
13045 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13046 ignored
13047
13048 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13049 applied
13050
13051 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13052 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13053
13054 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13055 retries the query with a new type
13056
13057 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13058 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013059
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013060As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13061a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013062<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013063
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013064
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013065resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013066 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013067
13068A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13069
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013070accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013071 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013072 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013073 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13074 by RFC 6891)
13075
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013076 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13077
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013078nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13079 DNS server description:
13080 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13081 <ip> : IP address of the server
13082 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13083
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013084parse-resolv-conf
13085 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13086 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13087 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13088
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013089hold <status> <period>
13090 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13091 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013092 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013093 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013094 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13095 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13096 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13097
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013098 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013099
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013100resolve_retries <nb>
13101 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13102 giving up.
13103 Default value: 3
13104
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013105 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13106 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13107 type.
13108
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013109timeout <event> <time>
13110 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13111 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13112 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013113 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13114 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013115 Default value: 1s
13116 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013117 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013118 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013119 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13120 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13121
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013122 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013123
13124 resolvers mydns
13125 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13126 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013127 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013128 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013129 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013130 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013131 hold other 30s
13132 hold refused 30s
13133 hold nx 30s
13134 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013135 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013136 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013137
13138
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131396. HTTP header manipulation
13140---------------------------
13141
13142In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
13143response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
13144request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
13145which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013146against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013147
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013148If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
13149to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
13150but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
13151HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
13152stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
13153because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
13154a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
13155still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020013156
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013157This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
13158in section 4.2 :
13159
13160 - reqadd <string>
13161 - reqallow <search>
13162 - reqiallow <search>
13163 - reqdel <search>
13164 - reqidel <search>
13165 - reqdeny <search>
13166 - reqideny <search>
13167 - reqpass <search>
13168 - reqipass <search>
13169 - reqrep <search> <replace>
13170 - reqirep <search> <replace>
13171 - reqtarpit <search>
13172 - reqitarpit <search>
13173 - rspadd <string>
13174 - rspdel <search>
13175 - rspidel <search>
13176 - rspdeny <search>
13177 - rspideny <search>
13178 - rsprep <search> <replace>
13179 - rspirep <search> <replace>
13180
13181With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
13182is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
13183parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
13184prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
13185Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
13186
13187 \t for a tab
13188 \r for a carriage return (CR)
13189 \n for a new line (LF)
13190 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
13191 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
13192 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
13193 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
13194 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
13195
13196The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
13197portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
13198above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
13199regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
132009 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
13201is very common to users of the "sed" program.
13202
13203The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
13204after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
13205
13206Notes related to these keywords :
13207---------------------------------
13208 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
13209 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
13210 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
13211
13212 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
13213 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
13214 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
13215
13216 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
13217 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
13218 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
13219 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
13220 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
13221
13222 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
13223 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
13224 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
13225 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
13226 useless headers before adding new ones.
13227
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013228 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013229 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
13230
13231 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
13232 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
13233 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
13234
13235 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
13236 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013237 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013238
13239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132407. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13241----------------------------------
13242
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013243HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013244client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13245The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13246these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13247but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13248data called patterns.
13249
13250
132517.1. ACL basics
13252---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013253
13254The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13255content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13256from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13257simple :
13258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013259 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013260 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013261 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13262 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013264The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13265adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013266
13267In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013269 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013270
13271This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13272Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13273and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013274an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13275conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13276as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13277are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013278
13279ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13280'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13281which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13282
13283There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13284performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013286The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13287specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13288this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013289methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13290ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013291
13292Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13293 - boolean
13294 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13295 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13296 - string
13297 - data block
13298
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013299Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13300converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13301would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13302The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13303which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13304
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013305Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13306keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13307fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13308which are summarized in the table below :
13309
13310 +---------------------+-----------------+
13311 | Sample or converter | Default |
13312 | output type | matching method |
13313 +---------------------+-----------------+
13314 | boolean | bool |
13315 +---------------------+-----------------+
13316 | integer | int |
13317 +---------------------+-----------------+
13318 | ip | ip |
13319 +---------------------+-----------------+
13320 | string | str |
13321 +---------------------+-----------------+
13322 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13323 +---------------------+-----------------+
13324
13325Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13326matching method, see below.
13327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013328The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13329 - boolean
13330 - integer or integer range
13331 - IP address / network
13332 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13333 - regular expression
13334 - hex block
13335
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013336The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13337
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013338 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13339 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013340 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013341 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013342 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013343 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013344 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013346The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13347read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13348if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13349lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13350will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13351beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13352a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13353lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13354exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13355
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013356The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13357parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13358ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13359a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13360check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13361
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013362The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13363socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13364file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013366Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13367loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13368
13369 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13370
13371In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13372the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13373case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13374as well.
13375
13376The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13377sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13378do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13379methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13380is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013381obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013382followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13383default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13384that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13385string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13386
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013387The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13388By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13389string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13390resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13391server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013392waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013393flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13394function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013396There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13397sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13398be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013399
13400 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13401 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013402 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13403 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13404 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13405 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013406
13407 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13408 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013409 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013410
13411 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013412 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013413
13414 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013415 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013416
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013417 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013418 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13419
13420 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13421 binary or string samples.
13422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013423 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13424 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013426 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13427 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13428 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013430 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13431 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013433 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13434 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013436 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13437 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013439 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13440 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013441 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013443 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13444 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13445 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013446
13447For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13448request, it is possible to do :
13449
13450 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13451
13452In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13453buffer, one would use the following acl :
13454
13455 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13456
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013457On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13458possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13459
13460 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013462All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13463criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13464method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13465to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13466criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13467the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013469If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013470the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13471For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013473 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13474 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13475 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13476 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013477
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013478
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013479The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13480types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13481combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13482brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13483default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013485 +-------------------------------------------------+
13486 | Input sample type |
13487 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013488 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013489 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13490 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13491 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013492 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013493 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013494 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013495 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013496 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013497 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013498 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013499 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013500 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013501 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013502 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013503 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013504 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013505 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013506 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013507 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013508 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013509 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013510 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013511 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013512 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013513 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13514 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13515 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013516
13517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135187.1.1. Matching booleans
13519------------------------
13520
13521In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13522Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13523When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13524that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13525
13526Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13527return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13528"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13529
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135317.1.2. Matching integers
13532------------------------
13533
13534Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13535enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13536to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13537
13538Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13539matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13540lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013541
13542For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13543unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13544representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13545
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013546As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13547two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13548instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13549ranges and operators.
13550
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013551For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013552operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13553Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13554of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013556Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013557
13558 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13559 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13560 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13561 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13562 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13563
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013564For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013565
13566 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13567
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013568This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13569
13570 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13571
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135737.1.3. Matching strings
13574-----------------------
13575
13576String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13577different forms :
13578
13579 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013580 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013581
13582 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013583 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013584
13585 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13586 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13587
13588 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13589 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13590
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013591 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013592 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13593 matches.
13594
13595 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13596 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13597 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013598
13599String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13600exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13601characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13602string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13603to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013604before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013605
Mathias Weiersmuellerb2fe2232019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013606Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13607(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13608Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13609
13610Example:
13611 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13612 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13613
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136157.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13616---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013617
13618Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13619they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13620possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13621passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13622the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013623the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13624match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013625
13626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136277.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13628-------------------------------------
13629
13630It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13631not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13632a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13633to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13634digits may be used upper or lower case.
13635
13636Example :
13637 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13638 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13639
13640
136417.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13642---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013643
13644IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13645netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13646within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013647host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013648difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13649at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13650does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13651parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013652
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013653The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13654abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13655
13656 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13657 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13658 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13659 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13660 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13661 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13662 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13663 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13664
13665Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13666192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13667
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013668IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13669Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13670trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13671IPv6 patterns.
13672
13673HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13674following situations :
13675 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13676 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13677 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13678 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13679 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13680 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13681 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13682 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13683 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13684 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013686
136877.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13688----------------------------------
13689
13690Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13691combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13692
13693 - AND (implicit)
13694 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13695 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013697A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013699 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013701Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13702indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013704For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13705"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13706requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13707is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13708
13709 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013710 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13711 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13712 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013713
13714To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13715and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13716
13717 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13718 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13719 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13720 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13721
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013722 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013723 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13724 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13725 use_backend www if host_www
13726
13727It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13728expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13729be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13730the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13731
13732 The following rule :
13733
13734 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013735 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013736
13737 Can also be written that way :
13738
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013739 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013740
13741It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13742to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13743simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13744sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13745good use is the following :
13746
13747 With named ACLs :
13748
13749 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13750 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13751 monitor fail if site_dead
13752
13753 With anonymous ACLs :
13754
13755 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13756
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013757See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13758keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013759
13760
137617.3. Fetching samples
13762---------------------
13763
13764Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13765against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13766sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13767ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13768of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13769available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13770
13771This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13772Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13773compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13774deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13775
13776The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13777matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13778method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13779indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13780
13781As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13782when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13783mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13784the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13785ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13786
13787Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13788multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13789when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013790incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13791are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013792is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13793all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13794
13795Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13796 - name
13797 - name(arg1)
13798 - name(arg1,arg2)
13799
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013800
138017.3.1. Converters
13802-----------------
13803
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013804Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13805of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13806is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13807was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013808has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013809unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13810
13811These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13812sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13813the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013814support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013815
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013816A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13817support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13818supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13819(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13820bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013822The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013823
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001382451d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13825 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13826 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13827 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13828 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13829 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13830
13831 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013832 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13833 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013834 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13835 frontend http-in
13836 bind *:8081
13837 default_backend servers
13838 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13839 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13840
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013841add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013842 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013843 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013844 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13845 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013846 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013847 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13848 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13849 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13850 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013851 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013852 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013853
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013854aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13855 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13856 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13857 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13858 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13859 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13860 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13861
13862 Example:
13863 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13864 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13865
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013866and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013867 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013868 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013869 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13870 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013871 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013872 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13873 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13874 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13875 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013876 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013877 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013878
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013879b64dec
13880 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13881 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13882
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013883base64
13884 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013885 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013886 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13887
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013888bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013889 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013890 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013891 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013892 presence of a flag).
13893
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013894bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13895 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13896 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013897 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013898
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013899concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13900 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13901 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13902 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13903 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13904 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13905 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13906 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13907 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13908 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13909 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013910 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013911 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013912 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013913
13914 Example:
13915 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13916 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13917 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13918 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13919
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013920cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013921 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13922 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013923
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013924crc32([<avalanche>])
13925 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13926 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13927 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13928 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13929 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13930 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13931 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13932 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13933 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13934 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013935 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13936
13937crc32c([<avalanche>])
13938 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13939 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13940 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13941 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13942 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13943 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13944 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13945 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013946
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013947da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013948 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13949 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13950 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13951 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013952 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013953 configuration language.
13954
13955 Example:
13956 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013957 bind *:8881
13958 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013959 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013960
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013961debug
13962 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13963 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13964 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13965
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013966div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013967 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13968 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013969 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013970 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13971 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013972 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013973 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13974 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13975 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13976 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013977 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013978 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013979
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013980djb2([<avalanche>])
13981 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13982 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13983 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13984 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13985 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13986 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13987 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013988 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13989 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013990
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013991even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013992 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013993 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13994
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013995field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13996 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13997 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13998 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13999 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14000 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14001 fields.
14002
14003 Example :
14004 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14005 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14006 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14007 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14008 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014009
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014010hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014011 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014012 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014013 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014014 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014015
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014016hex2i
14017 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014018 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014019
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014020http_date([<offset>])
14021 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14022 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
14023 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
14024 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
14025 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
14026 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014027
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014028in_table(<table>)
14029 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14030 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14031 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014032 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014033 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14034
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014035ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14036 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014037 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014038 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14039 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14040 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14041 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14042 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014043
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014044json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014045 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014046 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014047 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014048 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14049 of errors:
14050 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14051 bytes, ...)
14052 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14053 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14054
14055 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14056 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14057 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14058 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14059 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14060 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014061 - "ascii" : never fails;
14062 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14063 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014064 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014065 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014066 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14067 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14068
14069 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014070 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014071
14072 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014073 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014074 capture request header user-agent len 150
14075 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014076
14077 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14078 GET / HTTP/1.0
14079 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14080
14081 Output log:
14082 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14083
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014084language(<value>[,<default>])
14085 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14086 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14087 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14088 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14089 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14090 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14091 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14092 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14093 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014094 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014095 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14096 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014097
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014098 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014099
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014100 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14101 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014102
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014103 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14104 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14105 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14106 use_backend spanish if es
14107 use_backend french if fr
14108 use_backend english if en
14109 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014110
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014111length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014112 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14113 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14114 type. The result is of type integer.
14115
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014116lower
14117 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14118 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14119 type. The result is of type string.
14120
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014121ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14122 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14123 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14124 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14125 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14126 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14127 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14128
14129 Example :
14130
14131 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014132 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014133 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14134
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014135map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14136map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14137map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14138 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14139 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14140 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14141 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14142 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14143 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14144 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14145 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014146
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014147 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14148 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14149 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014150
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014151 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014152 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014153
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014154 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14155 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14156 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14157 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014158 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14159 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014160 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14161 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14162 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14163 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14164 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14165 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14166 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14167 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014168 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14169 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14170 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014171 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14172 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14173 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14174 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14175 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014176
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014177 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14178 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14179 the corresponding match text.
14180
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014181 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14182 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14183 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14184 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14185 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014186
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014187 Example :
14188
14189 # this is a comment and is ignored
14190 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14191 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14192 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14193 | | | `---------- value
14194 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14195 | `---------------------------- key
14196 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14197
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014198mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014199 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14200 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014201 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014202 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014203 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014204 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14205 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14206 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14207 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014208 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014209 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014210
14211mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014212 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014213 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14214 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014215 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014216 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014217 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014218 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14219 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14220 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14221 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014222 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014223 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014224
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014225nbsrv
14226 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14227 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14228 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14229 map lookup.
14230
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014231neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014232 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14233 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14234 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14235 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014236
14237not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014238 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014239 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014240 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014241 absence of a flag).
14242
14243odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014244 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014245 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14246
14247or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014248 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014249 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014250 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14251 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014252 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014253 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14254 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14255 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14256 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014257 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014258 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014259
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014260protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14261 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14262 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14263 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14264 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14265 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14266 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14267 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14268 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14269 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14270 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14271 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14272
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014273regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014274 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14275 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14276 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14277 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14278 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14279 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14280 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14281 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14282 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
14283 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010014284 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
14285 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
14286 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
14287 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014288
14289 Example :
14290
14291 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14292 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14293 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14294 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14295
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014296capture-req(<id>)
14297 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14298 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14299
14300 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014301 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14302 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014303
14304capture-res(<id>)
14305 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14306 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14307
14308 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014309 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14310 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014311
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014312sdbm([<avalanche>])
14313 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14314 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14315 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14316 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14317 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14318 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14319 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014320 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14321 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014322
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014323set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014324 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14325 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14326 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014327 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014328 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14329 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014330 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014331 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14332 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014333 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014334 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014335
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014336sha1
14337 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
14338 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14339
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014340strcmp(<var>)
14341 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14342 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14343 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14344 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14345 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14346 shorter).
14347
14348 Example :
14349
14350 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14351 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14352 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14353
14354
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014355sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014356 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14357 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014358 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014359 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14360 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014361 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014362 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14363 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014364 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014365 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14366 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014367 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014368 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014369
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014370table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14371 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14372 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14373 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14374 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14375 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14376 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14377
14378
14379table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14380 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14381 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14382 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14383 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14384 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14385 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14386
14387table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14388 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14389 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014390 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014391 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14392 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14393
14394table_conn_cur(<table>)
14395 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14396 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14397 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14398 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14399 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14400
14401table_conn_rate(<table>)
14402 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14403 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14404 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14405 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14406 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14407
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014408table_gpt0(<table>)
14409 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14410 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14411 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14412 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14413 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14414
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014415table_gpc0(<table>)
14416 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14417 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14418 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14419 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14420 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14421
14422table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14423 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14424 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14425 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14426 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14427 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14428 sample fetch keyword.
14429
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014430table_gpc1(<table>)
14431 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14432 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14433 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14434 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14435 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14436
14437table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14438 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14439 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14440 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14441 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14442 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14443 sample fetch keyword.
14444
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014445table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14446 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14447 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014448 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014449 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14450 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14451
14452table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14453 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14454 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14455 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14456 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14457 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14458 keyword.
14459
14460table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14461 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14462 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014463 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014464 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14465 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14466
14467table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14468 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14469 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14470 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14471 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14472 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14473 keyword.
14474
14475table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14476 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14477 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014478 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014479 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14480 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14481 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14482 keyword.
14483
14484table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14485 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14486 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014487 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014488 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14489 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14490 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14491 keyword.
14492
14493table_server_id(<table>)
14494 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14495 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14496 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14497 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14498 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14499 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14500
14501table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14502 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14503 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014504 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014505 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14506 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14507 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14508 keyword.
14509
14510table_sess_rate(<table>)
14511 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14512 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14513 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14514 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14515 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14516 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14517 keyword.
14518
14519table_trackers(<table>)
14520 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14521 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14522 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14523 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14524 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14525 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14526 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14527 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14528 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14529 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14530
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014531upper
14532 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14533 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14534 type. The result is of type string.
14535
Willy Tarreau7e913cb2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020014536url_dec([<in_form>])
14537 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
14538 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
14539 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
14540 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
14541 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
14542 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014543
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014544ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014545 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014546 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14547 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14548 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014549 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14550 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14551 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14552 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014553 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014554 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14555 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014556
14557 Example:
14558 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14559 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14560
14561 message Point {
14562 int32 latitude = 1;
14563 int32 longitude = 2;
14564 }
14565
14566 message PPoint {
14567 Point point = 59;
14568 }
14569
14570 message Rectangle {
14571 // One corner of the rectangle.
14572 PPoint lo = 48;
14573 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14574 PPoint hi = 49;
14575 }
14576
14577 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14578 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14579 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14580
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014581 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14582 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014583 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014584 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14585
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014586 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014587
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014588 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014589
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014590 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014591 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14592 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14593
14594 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14595 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14596 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14597
14598 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14599 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14600 interpret the previous binary sample.
14601
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014602
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014603unset-var(<var name>)
14604 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14605 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14606 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14607 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14608 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14609 response),
14610 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14611 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14612 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14613 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14614
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014615utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14616 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14617 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14618 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14619 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14620 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14621 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14622
14623 Example :
14624
14625 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014626 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014627 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14628
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014629word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14630 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14631 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14632 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnind1fa5fa2020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014633 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014634 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14635 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14636
14637 Example :
14638 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14639 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14640 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14641 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14642 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnind1fa5fa2020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014643 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014644
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014645wt6([<avalanche>])
14646 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14647 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14648 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14649 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14650 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14651 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14652 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014653 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14654 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014655
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014656xor(<value>)
14657 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014658 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014659 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014660 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014661 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014662 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14663 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014664 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014665 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14666 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014667 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014668 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014669
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014670xxh32([<seed>])
14671 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14672 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14673 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14674 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14675 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14676 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14677 as cryptographically secure.
14678
14679xxh64([<seed>])
14680 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14681 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14682 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14683 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14684 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14685 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14686 as cryptographically secure.
14687
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014688
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146897.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014690--------------------------------------------
14691
14692A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14693not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14694"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14695The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14696
14697always_false : boolean
14698 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14699 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14700
14701always_true : boolean
14702 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14703 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14704
14705avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014706 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014707 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14708 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14709 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14710 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14711 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14712 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14713 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14714 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14715 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14716 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14717 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14718 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14719 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014721be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014722 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14723 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14724 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14725 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014726 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14727
14728be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14729 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14730 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14731 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14732 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14733 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014734 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14735 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014736
14737 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14738 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14739 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014741be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14742 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14743 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14744 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014745 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014746 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14747 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014748
14749 Example :
14750 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14751 backend dynamic
14752 mode http
14753 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14754 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014755
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014756bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014757 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14758 of the string.
14759
14760bool(<bool>) : bool
14761 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14762 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014764connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14765 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014766 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014767 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14768 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014769
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014770 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014771 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014772 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14773
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014774 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14775 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014776
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014777 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014778 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014779 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014780 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014781 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014782 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014783 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014784
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014785 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14786 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014787 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014788 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014789
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014790cpu_calls : integer
14791 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14792 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14793 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14794 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14795 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14796 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14797
14798cpu_ns_avg : integer
14799 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14800 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14801 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14802 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14803 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14804 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14805 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14806 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14807 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14808 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14809 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14810
14811cpu_ns_tot : integer
14812 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14813 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14814 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14815 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14816 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14817 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14818 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14819 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14820 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14821 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14822 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14823 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14824 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14825
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014826date([<offset>]) : integer
14827 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14828 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14829 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14830 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014831 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14832
14833 Example :
14834
14835 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14836 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014837
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014838date_us : integer
14839 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14840 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14841 from the same timeval structure.
14842
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014843distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14844 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14845 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14846 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14847 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14848 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14849 list of supported tokens.
14850
14851distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14852 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14853 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14854 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14855 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14856 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14857 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14858 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14859 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14860 supported tokens.
14861
14862 Example :
14863 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14864 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14865 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14866 # send large files to the big farm
14867 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14868
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014869env(<name>) : string
14870 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14871 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14872 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14873 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14874 certain way.
14875
14876 Examples :
14877 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14878 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14879
14880 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14881 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014883fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14884 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014885 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14886 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014887 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14888 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014889 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014890 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14891 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014892
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014893fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14894 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14895 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14896 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014898fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14899 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14900 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14901 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14902 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14903 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14904 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14905 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14906 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014907
14908 Example :
14909 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14910 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14911 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14912 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14913 frontend mail
14914 bind :25
14915 mode tcp
14916 maxconn 100
14917 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14918 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14919 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14920 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014921
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014922hostname : string
14923 Returns the system hostname.
14924
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014925int(<integer>) : signed integer
14926 Returns a signed integer.
14927
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014928ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14929 Returns an ipv4.
14930
14931ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14932 Returns an ipv6.
14933
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014934lat_ns_avg : integer
14935 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14936 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14937 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14938 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14939 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14940 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14941 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14942 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14943 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14944 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14945 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14946 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14947 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14948 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14949
14950lat_ns_tot : integer
14951 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14952 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14953 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14954 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14955 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14956 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14957 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14958 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14959 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14960 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14961 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14962 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14963 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14964 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14965 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14966 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14967 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14968 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14969 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14970
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014971meth(<method>) : method
14972 Returns a method.
14973
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014974nbproc : integer
14975 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14976 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14977 and debugging purposes.
14978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014979nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14980 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14981 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14982 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014983 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14984 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14985 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014986
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014987prio_class : integer
14988 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14989 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14990 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14991
14992prio_offset : integer
14993 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14994 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14995 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14996 set-priority-offset".
14997
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014998proc : integer
14999 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15000 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15001 debugging purposes.
15002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015003queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015004 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15005 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15006 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015007 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15008 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15009 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15010 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15011 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15012
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015013rand([<range>]) : integer
15014 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15015 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15016 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15017 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15018 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15019
Luca Schimweg77306662019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015020uuid([<version>]) : string
15021 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15022 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15023 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015025srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15026 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15027 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15028 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15029 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15030 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015031 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15032 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15033
15034srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15035 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15036 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15037 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15038 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15039 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15040 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15041 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15042
15043 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15044 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015045
15046srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15047 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15048 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15049 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015050 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015051 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15052 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15053 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15054
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015055srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15056 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15057 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15058 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15059 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15060 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15061 fetch methods.
15062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015063srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15064 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15065 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015066 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015067 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15068 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015069 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015070 overloading servers).
15071
15072 Example :
15073 # Redirect to a separate back
15074 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15075 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15076 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15077
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015078stopping : boolean
15079 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15080 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15081 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15082
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015083str(<string>) : string
15084 Returns a string.
15085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015086table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15087 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15088 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15089
15090table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15091 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15092 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15093 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15094
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015095thread : integer
15096 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15097 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15098 and debugging purposes.
15099
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015100var(<var-name>) : undefined
15101 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015102 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15103 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015104 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015105 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15106 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015107 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015108 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15109 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015110 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015111 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015112
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151137.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015114----------------------------------
15115
15116The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15117closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15118methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15119sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15120TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015121the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15122counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015123"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15124used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15125can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15126Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15127table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15128tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15129currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015130
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015131bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015132 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15133 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15134 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015136be_id : integer
15137 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15138 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15139
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015140be_name : string
15141 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15142 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015144dst : ip
15145 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15146 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15147 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15148 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015149 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15150 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15151 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15152 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15153 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15154 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015155
15156dst_conn : integer
15157 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15158 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15159 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15160 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15161 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15162 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15163 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15164 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015165
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015166dst_is_local : boolean
15167 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15168 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15169 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15170 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015171 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015172 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15173 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15174 it only once per connection.
15175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015176dst_port : integer
15177 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15178 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15179 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15180 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15181 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15182 an HTTP header.
15183
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015184fc_http_major : integer
15185 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15186 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15187 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15188
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015189fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15190 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15191 header.
15192
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015193fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15194 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15195 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15196 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15197 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15198 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15199 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15200
15201fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15202 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15203 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15204 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15205 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15206 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15207 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15208
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015209fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015210 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15211 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15212 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15213 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15214
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015215fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015216 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15217 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15218 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15219 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15220
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015221fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015222 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15223 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15224 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15225 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15226
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015227fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015228 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15229 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15230 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15231 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15232
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015233fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015234 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15235 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15236 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15237 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15238
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015239fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015240 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15241 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15242 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15243 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15244
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015245fe_defbe : string
15246 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15247 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015249fe_id : integer
15250 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015251 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015252 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15253
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015254fe_name : string
15255 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15256 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15257 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15258
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015259sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015260sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15261sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15262sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015263 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15264 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15265 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15266
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015267sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015268sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15269sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15270sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015271 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15272 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15273 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15274
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015275sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015276sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15277sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15278sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015279 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15280 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015281 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15282 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15283 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015284
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015285 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015286 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15287 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015288 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15289 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15290 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015291 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15292 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15293
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015294sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15295sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15296sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15297sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15298 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15299 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15300 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15301 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15302 when a first ACL was verified.
15303
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015304sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015305sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15306sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15307sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015308 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015309 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15310
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015311sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015312sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15313sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15314sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015315 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15316 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15317 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15318
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015319sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015320sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15321sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15322sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015323 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15324 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15325 See also src_conn_rate.
15326
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015327sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015328sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15329sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15330sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015331 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015332 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015333
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015334sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15335sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15336sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15337sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15338 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15339 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15340
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015341sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15342sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15343sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15344sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15345 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15346 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15347
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015348sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015349sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15350sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15351sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015352 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15353 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15354 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015355 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15356 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15357 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015358
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015359sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15360sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15361sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15362sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15363 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15364 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15365 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15366 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15367 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15368 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15369
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015370sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015371sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15372sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15373sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015374 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015375 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15376 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15377
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015378sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015379sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15380sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15381sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015382 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15383 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15384 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15385 src_http_err_rate.
15386
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015387sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015388sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15389sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15390sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015391 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015392 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15393 src_http_req_cnt.
15394
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015395sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015396sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15397sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15398sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015399 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15400 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15401 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15402 src_http_req_rate.
15403
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015404sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015405sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15406sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15407sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015408 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015409 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15410 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15411 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15412 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015413
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015414 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015415 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15416 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015417 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15418
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015419sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15420sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15421sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15422sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15423 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15424 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15425 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15426 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15427 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15428
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015429sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015430sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15431sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15432sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015433 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15434 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15435 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015436
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015437sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015438sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15439sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15440sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015441 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15442 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15443 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015444
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015445sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015446sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15447sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15448sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015449 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015450 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15451 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15452 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015453 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015454 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15455
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015456sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015457sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15458sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15459sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015460 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15461 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15462 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15463 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15464 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015465 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015466
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015467sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015468sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15469sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15470sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015471 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15472 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15473 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15474
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015475sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015476sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15477sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15478sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015479 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15480 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015481 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015482 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15483 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015484 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15485 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15486 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015488so_id : integer
15489 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15490 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15491 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015492
Jerome Magnin28b90332020-03-27 22:08:40 +010015493so_name : string
15494 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
15495 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
15496 strings instead of integers.
15497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015498src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015499 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015500 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15501 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15502 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015503 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15504 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15505 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015506 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15507 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15508 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15509 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15510 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15511 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15512 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015513
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015514 Example:
15515 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15516 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015518src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15519 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15520 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15521 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015522 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015524src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15525 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15526 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015527 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015528 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015530src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15531 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15532 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15533 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15534 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15535 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15536 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015537
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015538 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015539 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15540 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15541 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15542 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015543 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015544 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15545 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15546
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015547src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15548 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15549 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15550 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15551 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15552 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15553 was verified.
15554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015555src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015556 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015557 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015558 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015559 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015561src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015562 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015563 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15564 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015565 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015567src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15568 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15569 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15570 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015571 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015573src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015574 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015575 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015576 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015577 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015578
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015579src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15580 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15581 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15582 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15583 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15584
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015585src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15586 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15587 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15588 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15589 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015591src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015592 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015593 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015594 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15595 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015596 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15597 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15598 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015599
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015600src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15601 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15602 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15603 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15604 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15605 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15606 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15607 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015609src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015610 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015611 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015612 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015613 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015614 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015616src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15617 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15618 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15619 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15620 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015621 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015623src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015624 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015625 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15626 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015627 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015629src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15630 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15631 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15632 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015633 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015634 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015636src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15637 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15638 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15639 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015640 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015641 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15642 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015643
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015644 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015645 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015646 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015647 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015648
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015649src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15650 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15651 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15652 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15653 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15654 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15655 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15656
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015657src_is_local : boolean
15658 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15659 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15660 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15661 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015662 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015663 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15664 once per connection.
15665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015666src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015667 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15668 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15669 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15670 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15671 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015673src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015674 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15675 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15676 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15677 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15678 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680src_port : integer
15681 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15682 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15683 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15684 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015686src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015687 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015688 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15689 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15690 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015691 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15694 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15695 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15696 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15697 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015698 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015700src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15701 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15702 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15703 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15704 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15705 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15706 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15707 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15708 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015709
15710 Example :
15711 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15712 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15713 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15714 listen ssh
15715 bind :22
15716 mode tcp
15717 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015718 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015719 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015720 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015722srv_id : integer
15723 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15724 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15725 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015726
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157277.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015728----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015730The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15731closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15732when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15733usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015734future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015735
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001573651d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15737 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15738 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15739 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15740 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15741 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15742
15743 Example :
15744 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15745 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15746 # the request.
15747 frontend http-in
15748 bind *:8081
15749 default_backend servers
15750 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15751 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15752
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015753ssl_bc : boolean
15754 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15755 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15756 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15757
15758ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15759 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15760 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15761
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015762ssl_bc_alpn : string
15763 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15764 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015765 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015766 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15767 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15768 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15769 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15770 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15771 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15772
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015773ssl_bc_cipher : string
15774 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15775 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15776
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015777ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15778 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15779 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15780 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15781
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015782ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15783 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15784 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15785 session or a TLS ticket.
15786
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015787ssl_bc_npn : string
15788 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15789 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015790 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015791 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15792 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15793 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15794 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15795 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15796
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015797ssl_bc_protocol : string
15798 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15799 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15800
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015801ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015802 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015803 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15804 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015805
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015806ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15807 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15808 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15809 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15810
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015811ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15812 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15813 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15814 if session was reused or not.
15815
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015816ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15817 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15818 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15819 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15820 BoringSSL.
15821
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015822ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15823 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15824 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015826ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15827 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15828 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15829 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15830 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15831 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015833ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15834 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15835 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15836 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15837 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015838
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015839ssl_c_der : binary
15840 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15841 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15842 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015844ssl_c_err : integer
15845 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15846 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15847 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15848 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15849 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015851ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15852 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15853 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15854 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15855 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15856 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15857 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15858 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15859 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015861ssl_c_key_alg : string
15862 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15863 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15864 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015866ssl_c_notafter : string
15867 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15868 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15869 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015871ssl_c_notbefore : string
15872 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15873 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15874 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015876ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15877 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15878 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15879 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15880 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15881 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15882 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15883 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15884 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015886ssl_c_serial : binary
15887 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15888 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15889 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015891ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15892 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15893 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15894 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015895 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15896 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15897
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015898 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015899 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015901ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15902 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15903 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15904 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015906ssl_c_used : boolean
15907 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15908 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015910ssl_c_verify : integer
15911 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15912 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15913 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15914 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015916ssl_c_version : integer
15917 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15918 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015919
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015920ssl_f_der : binary
15921 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15922 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15923 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015925ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15926 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15927 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15928 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15929 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015930 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015931 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15932 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15933 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015935ssl_f_key_alg : string
15936 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15937 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15938 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015940ssl_f_notafter : string
15941 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15942 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15943 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015945ssl_f_notbefore : string
15946 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15947 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15948 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015950ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15951 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15952 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15953 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15954 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15955 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15956 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15957 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15958 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015960ssl_f_serial : binary
15961 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15962 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15963 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015964
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015965ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15966 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15967 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15968 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015970ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15971 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15972 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15973 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015975ssl_f_version : integer
15976 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15977 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15978
15979ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015980 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15981 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15982 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015984 Example :
15985 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15986 listen http-https
15987 bind :80
15988 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15989 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15990
15991ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15992 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15993 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15994
15995ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015996 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015997 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15998 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15999 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16000 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16001 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16002 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16003 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16004 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016006ssl_fc_cipher : string
16007 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16008 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016009
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016010ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16011 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16012 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016013 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016014
16015ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16016 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16017 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016018 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016019
16020ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16021 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16022 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16023 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016024 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016025 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016026
16027ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16028 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16029 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016030 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016031
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016032ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16033 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16034 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16035 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016037ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016038 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16039 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016040 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16041 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16042 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16043 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016044
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016045ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16046 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16047 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16048 wait until the handshake happened.
16049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016050ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16051 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016052 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16053 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016054 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016055 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016056
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016057ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016058 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016059 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16060 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016062ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016063 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016064 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16065 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16066 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16067 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16068 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16069 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16070 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016072ssl_fc_protocol : string
16073 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16074 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016075
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016076ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016077 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016078 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16079 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016080
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016081ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16082 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16083 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16084 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016086ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16087 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16088 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16089 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16090 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016091
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016092ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16093 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16094 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16095 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16096 BoringSSL.
16097
16098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016099ssl_fc_sni : string
16100 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16101 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16102 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16103 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16104 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16105
16106 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16107 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16108 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016109 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016110 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016112 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016113 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16114 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016116ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16117 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16118 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016119
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016120
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161217.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016122------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016124Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16125sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16126only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16127For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16128be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16129can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16130sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16131for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16132content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016134payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016135 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016136 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16137 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016139payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16140 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016141 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016142 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016143
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016144req.hdrs : string
16145 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16146 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16147 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16148 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16149
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016150req.hdrs_bin : binary
16151 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16152 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16153 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16154 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16155 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16156 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16157
16158 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16159
16160 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16161 str: <int:length><bytes>
16162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016163req.len : integer
16164req_len : integer (deprecated)
16165 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16166 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16167 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16168 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16169 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16170 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16171 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16172 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016174req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16175 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016176 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16177 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16178 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16179 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016181 ACL alternatives :
16182 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016184req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16185 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16186 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16187 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16188 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016190 ACL alternatives :
16191 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016193 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016195req.proto_http : boolean
16196req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16197 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16198 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16199 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16200 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16201 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16202 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16203 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016205 Example:
16206 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16207 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16208 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016209 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016211req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16212rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16213 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16214 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16215 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16216 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16217 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16218 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16219 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016221 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16222 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16223 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16224 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16225 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16226 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016228 ACL derivatives :
16229 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016231 Example :
16232 listen tse-farm
16233 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16234 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16235 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16236 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16237 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16238 persist rdp-cookie
16239 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16240 # This is only useful makes sense if
16241 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16242 stick-table type string size 204800
16243 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16244 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16245 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016247 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16248 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016250req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16251rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16252 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16253 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16254 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16255 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016257 ACL derivatives :
16258 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016259
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016260req.ssl_alpn : string
16261 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16262 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16263 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16264 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16265 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16266 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016267 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016268
16269 Examples :
16270 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16271 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16272 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016273 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016274 default_backend bk_default
16275
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016276req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16277 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16278 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016279 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16280 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16281 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16282 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16283 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016285req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16286req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16287 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16288 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16289 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16290 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16291 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16292 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16293 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016295req.ssl_sni : string
16296req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16297 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16298 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16299 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16300 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16301 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16302 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16303 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16304 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16305 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16306 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16307 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16308 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016310 ACL derivatives :
16311 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016313 Examples :
16314 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16315 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16316 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16317 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16318 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016319
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016320req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16321 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16322 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16323 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16324 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16325 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16326 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16327 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16328 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16329 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016331req.ssl_ver : integer
16332req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16333 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16334 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16335 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16336 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16337 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16338 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16339 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016340 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016341 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016343 ACL derivatives :
16344 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016345
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016346res.len : integer
16347 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16348 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16349 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16350 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16351 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16352 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16353 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16354 content inspection.
16355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016356res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16357 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016358 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16359 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16360 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16361 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016363res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16364 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16365 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16366 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16367 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016369 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016370
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016371res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16372rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16373 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16374 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16375 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16376 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16377 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16378 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16379 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016381wait_end : boolean
16382 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16383 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016384 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016385 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16386 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016387 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016388 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16389 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016391 Examples :
16392 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16393 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16394 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016396 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16397 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16398 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16399 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16400 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16401 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16402 tcp-request content reject
16403
16404
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200164057.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016406--------------------------------------
16407
16408It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16409This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16410data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16411its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16412HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16413content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16414to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16415more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16416response are indexed.
16417
16418base : string
16419 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16420 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16421 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16422 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16423 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16424 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16425 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16426 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16427
16428 ACL derivatives :
16429 base : exact string match
16430 base_beg : prefix match
16431 base_dir : subdir match
16432 base_dom : domain match
16433 base_end : suffix match
16434 base_len : length match
16435 base_reg : regex match
16436 base_sub : substring match
16437
16438base32 : integer
16439 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16440 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16441 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016442 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16443 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16444 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016445
16446base32+src : binary
16447 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16448 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16449 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16450 per-URL counters.
16451
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016452capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16453 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16454 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16455 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16456
16457capture.req.method : string
16458 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16459 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16460 because it's allocated.
16461
16462capture.req.uri : string
16463 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16464 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16465 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16466 allocated.
16467
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016468capture.req.ver : string
16469 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16470 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16471 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16472
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016473capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16474 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16475 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16476 The first entry is an index of 0.
16477 See also: "capture response header"
16478
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016479capture.res.ver : string
16480 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16481 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16482 persistent flag.
16483
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016484req.body : binary
16485 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16486 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16487 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16488 the first chunk is analyzed.
16489
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016490req.body_param([<name>) : string
16491 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16492 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16493 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16494 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16495 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16496 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16497 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16498 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16499 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16500 given.
16501
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016502req.body_len : integer
16503 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16504 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16505 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16506 "option http-buffer-request".
16507
16508req.body_size : integer
16509 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16510 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16511 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16512 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16513 "option http-buffer-request".
16514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016515req.cook([<name>]) : string
16516cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16517 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16518 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16519 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16520 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16521 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16522 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16523 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16524 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16525
16526 ACL derivatives :
16527 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16528 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16529 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16530 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16531 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16532 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16533 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16534 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016536req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16537cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16538 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16539 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016541req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16542cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16543 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16544 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16545 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16546 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016548cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16549 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16550 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16551 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16552 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016553 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016554 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16555 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16556 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16557 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016559hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16560 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16561 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16562 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16563 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016564 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016566req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16567 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16568 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16569 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16570 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16571 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16572 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16573 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16574 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016576req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16577 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16578 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16579 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16580 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016582req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16583 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16584 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16585 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16586 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16587 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16588 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16589 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16590 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016591 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016592 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016593 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016595 ACL derivatives :
16596 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16597 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16598 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16599 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16600 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16601 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16602 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16603 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16604
16605req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16606hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16607 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16608 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16609 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16610 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16611 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16612 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16613 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16614 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16615 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16616
16617req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16618hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16619 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16620 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16621 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16622 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16623 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016624 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016625 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16626 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16627
16628req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16629hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16630 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16631 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16632 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16633 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16634 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16635 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16636 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16637
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016638
16639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016640http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16641 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16642 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16643 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16644 basic auth is supported.
16645
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016646http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16647 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16648 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16649 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16650 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016651 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16652 basic auth is supported.
16653
16654 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016655 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16656 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16657 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16658 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016659
16660http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016661 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16662 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016663 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16664 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016666method : integer + string
16667 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16668 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16669 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16670 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16671 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16672 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16673 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016675 ACL derivatives :
16676 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016678 Example :
16679 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16680 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16681 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016683path : string
16684 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16685 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16686 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16687 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16688 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016689 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016690 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016692 ACL derivatives :
16693 path : exact string match
16694 path_beg : prefix match
16695 path_dir : subdir match
16696 path_dom : domain match
16697 path_end : suffix match
16698 path_len : length match
16699 path_reg : regex match
16700 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016701
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016702query : string
16703 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16704 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16705 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16706 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016707 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016708 which stops before the question mark.
16709
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016710req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16711 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16712 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16713 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16714 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016716req.ver : string
16717req_ver : string (deprecated)
16718 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16719 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16720 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016722 ACL derivatives :
16723 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016725res.comp : boolean
16726 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16727 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16728 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016730res.comp_algo : string
16731 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16732 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16733 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016735res.cook([<name>]) : string
16736scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16737 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16738 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16739 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016741 ACL derivatives :
16742 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016744res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16745scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16746 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16747 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16748 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016750res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16751scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16752 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16753 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16754 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016756res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16757 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16758 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16759 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16760 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16761 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16762 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16763 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16764 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16765 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016767res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16768 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16769 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16770 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16771 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16772 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016774res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16775shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16776 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16777 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16778 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16779 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16780 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16781 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16782 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16783 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016785 ACL derivatives :
16786 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16787 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16788 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16789 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16790 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16791 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16792 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16793 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16794
16795res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16796shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16797 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16798 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16799 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16800 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16801 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016803res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16804shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16805 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16806 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16807 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16808 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16809 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16810 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016811
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016812res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16813 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16814 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16815 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16816 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016818res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16819shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16820 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16821 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16822 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16823 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16824 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16825 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016827res.ver : string
16828resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16829 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16830 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016832 ACL derivatives :
16833 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016835set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16836 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16837 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016838 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016839 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016841 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16842 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016844status : integer
16845 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16846 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16847 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016848
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016849unique-id : string
16850 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16851 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16852 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16853 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16854 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16855 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016857url : string
16858 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16859 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16860 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16861 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16862 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16863 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16864 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016866 ACL derivatives :
16867 url : exact string match
16868 url_beg : prefix match
16869 url_dir : subdir match
16870 url_dom : domain match
16871 url_end : suffix match
16872 url_len : length match
16873 url_reg : regex match
16874 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016876url_ip : ip
16877 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16878 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16879 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16880 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16881 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16882 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16883 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016885url_port : integer
16886 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16887 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16888 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16889 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016890
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016891urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16892url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016893 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16894 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016895 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16896 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16897 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16898 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016899 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16900 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016901 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16902 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016904 ACL derivatives :
16905 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16906 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16907 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16908 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16909 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16910 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16911 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16912 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016913
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016915 Example :
16916 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16917 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16918 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16919 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016920
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016921urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016922 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16923 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16924 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016925
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016926url32 : integer
16927 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16928 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16929 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16930 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16931 is an unsigned integer.
16932
16933url32+src : binary
16934 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16935 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16936 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16937
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200169397.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016940---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016941
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016942Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16943every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016944order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016945
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016946ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16947---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016948FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016949HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016950HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16951HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016952HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16953HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16954HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16955HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16956LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016957METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016958METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016959METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16960METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16961METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16962METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016963METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016964METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016965RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016966REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016967TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016968WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16969---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016970
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016971
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169728. Logging
16973----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016974
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016975One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16976provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16977very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16978provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16979state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016980to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016981headers.
16982
16983In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16984about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16985send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16986
16987 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16988 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16989 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16990 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16991 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016992 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016993 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016994
16995The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16996allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16997as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16998while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16999real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17000delay.
17001
17002
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170038.1. Log levels
17004---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017005
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017006TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017007source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017008HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17009in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17010track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17011syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17012about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017013
17014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170158.2. Log formats
17016----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017017
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017018HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017019and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17020slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17021options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017022
17023 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17024 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17025 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17026 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17027 extents.
17028
17029 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17030 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17031 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17032 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17033 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17034
17035 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17036 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17037 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17038 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17039 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17040
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017041 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17042 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17043 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17044 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17045
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017046 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17047
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017048Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17049specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17050field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17051servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17052always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17053identifier.
17054
17055Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17056 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17057 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17058 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17059 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17060
17061
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170628.2.1. Default log format
17063-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017064
17065This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17066as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17067format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17068
17069 Example :
17070 listen www
17071 mode http
17072 log global
17073 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17074
17075 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17076 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17077 (www/HTTP)
17078
17079 Field Format Extract from the example above
17080 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17081 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17082 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17083 4 'to' to
17084 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17085 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17086
17087Detailed fields description :
17088 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17089 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17090 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17091 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17092 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17093 and processed the connection.
17094 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17095
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017096In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17097"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17098connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17099
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017100It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17101will eventually disappear.
17102
17103
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171048.2.2. TCP log format
17105---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017106
17107The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17108is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17109information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17110counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17111emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17112environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17113the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17114sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017115specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17116not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17117fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17118marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017119
17120 Example :
17121 frontend fnt
17122 mode tcp
17123 option tcplog
17124 log global
17125 default_backend bck
17126
17127 backend bck
17128 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17129
17130 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17131 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17132 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17133
17134 Field Format Extract from the example above
17135 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17136 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17137 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17138 4 frontend_name fnt
17139 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17140 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17141 7 bytes_read* 212
17142 8 termination_state --
17143 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17144 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17145
17146Detailed fields description :
17147 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017148 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17149 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17150 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017151 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017152 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017153 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017154
17155 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017156 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17157 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17158 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017159
17160 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17161 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17162 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017163 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17164 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17165 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17166 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017167
17168 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17169 and processed the connection.
17170
17171 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17172 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17173 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17174 applications.
17175
17176 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17177 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17178 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17179 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17180 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17181
17182 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17183 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17184 See "Timers" below for more details.
17185
17186 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17187 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17188 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17189 "Timers" below for more details.
17190
17191 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017192 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017193 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17194 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17195 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17196 details.
17197
17198 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17199 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17200 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17201 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17202 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17203
17204 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17205 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17206 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17207 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17208 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17209 for more details.
17210
17211 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017212 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017213 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17214 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17215 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017216 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017217
17218 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17219 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17220 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17221 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17222 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17223 caused by a denial of service attack.
17224
17225 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17226 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17227 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17228 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17229 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17230 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17231 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17232 denial of service attack.
17233
17234 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17235 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17236 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17237 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17238 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17239 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17240 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17241 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17242 be processed than on other servers.
17243
17244 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17245 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17246 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17247 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17248 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17249 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17250 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17251 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17252 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17253 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17254 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17255 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17256 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17257
17258 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17259 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17260 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17261 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17262 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17263 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017264 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017265 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17266
17267 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17268 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17269 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17270 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17271 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17272 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017273 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017274 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17275 occurs.
17276
17277
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172788.2.3. HTTP log format
17279----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017280
17281The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17282is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17283the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17284are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17285emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17286generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17287"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17288which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017289frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17290is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017291
17292Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17293slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17294with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17295
17296 Example :
17297 frontend http-in
17298 mode http
17299 option httplog
17300 log global
17301 default_backend bck
17302
17303 backend static
17304 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17305
17306 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17307 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17308 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017309 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017310
17311 Field Format Extract from the example above
17312 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17313 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017314 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017315 4 frontend_name http-in
17316 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017317 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017318 7 status_code 200
17319 8 bytes_read* 2750
17320 9 captured_request_cookie -
17321 10 captured_response_cookie -
17322 11 termination_state ----
17323 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17324 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17325 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17326 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17327 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017328
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017329Detailed fields description :
17330 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017331 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17332 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17333 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017334 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017335 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017336 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017337
17338 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017339 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17340 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17341 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017342
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017343 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17344 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017345
17346 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17347 and processed the connection.
17348
17349 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17350 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17351 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17352
17353 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17354 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17355 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17356 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17357 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17358 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17359
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017360 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17361 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17362 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017363 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017364 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17365 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017366 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17367 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017368
17369 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17370 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017371 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017372
17373 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17374 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017375 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17376 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017377
17378 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17379 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17380 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17381 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17382 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017383 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17384 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017385
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017386 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17387 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17388 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17389 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17390 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17391 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17392 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017393 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017394
17395 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17396 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17397 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17398
17399 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17400 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017401 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017402 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17403 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17404 overflowing.
17405
17406 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17407 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17408 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17409 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17410 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17411 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17412 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17413 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17414
17415 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17416 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17417 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17418 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17419 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17420 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17421 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17422 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17423
17424 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17425 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17426 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17427 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17428 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17429 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17430 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17431
17432 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017433 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017434 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17435 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17436 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017437 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017438 system.
17439
17440 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17441 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17442 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17443 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17444 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17445 caused by a denial of service attack.
17446
17447 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17448 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17449 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17450 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17451 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17452 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17453 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17454 denial of service attack.
17455
17456 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17457 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17458 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17459 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17460 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17461 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17462 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17463 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17464 processed than on other servers.
17465
17466 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17467 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17468 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17469 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17470 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17471 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17472 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17473 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17474 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17475 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17476 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17477 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17478 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17479
17480 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17481 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17482 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17483 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17484 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17485 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017486 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017487 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17488
17489 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17490 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17491 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17492 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17493 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17494 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017495 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017496 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17497 occurs.
17498
17499 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17500 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17501 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17502 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17503 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17504 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17505 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17506 cookies" below for more details.
17507
17508 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17509 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17510 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17511 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17512 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17513 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17514 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17515 and cookies" below for more details.
17516
17517 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17518 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17519 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17520 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17521 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17522 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17523 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17524 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17525
17526
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200175278.2.4. Custom log format
17528------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017529
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017530The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017531mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017532
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017533HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017534Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17535separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17536prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17537
17538Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17539variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017540("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017541
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017542If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017543as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017544less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17545the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17546
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017547Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017548In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017549in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017550
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017551Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17552'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17553https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17554such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17555
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017556Flags are :
17557 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017558 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017559 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17560 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017561
17562 Example:
17563
17564 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17565 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17566
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017567 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17568
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017569At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17570
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017571 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17572 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017573
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017574the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017575
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017576 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17577 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17578 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017579
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017580and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17581
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017582 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17583 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017584
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017585Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17586
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017587 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017588 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017589 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17590 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17591 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017592 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17593 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17594 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017595 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017596 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17597 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017598 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017599 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17600 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017601 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017602 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017603 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017604 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017605 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017606 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017607 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017608 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17609 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17610 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17611 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17612 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017613 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017614 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17615 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017616 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017617 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17618 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017619 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17620 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17621 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017622 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017623 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17624 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017625 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017626 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17627 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17628 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017629 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017630 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017631 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17632 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17633 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17634 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017635 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017636 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017637 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017638 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017639 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017640 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017641 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17642 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17643 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017644 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017645 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17646 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017647 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017648 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17649 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017650 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017651 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017652 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017653 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017654
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017655 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017656
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017657
176588.2.5. Error log format
17659-----------------------
17660
17661When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17662protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17663By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17664"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017665will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017666logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17667
17668The format looks like this :
17669
17670 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17671 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17672 Connection error during SSL handshake
17673
17674 Field Format Extract from the example above
17675 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17676 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17677 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17678 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17679 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17680
17681These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17682failures.
17683
17684
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176858.3. Advanced logging options
17686-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017687
17688Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17689just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17690options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17691for more information about their usage.
17692
17693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176948.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17695------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017696
17697It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17698haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17699commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17700monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17701ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17702
17703 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17704 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17705 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17706 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17707
17708 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17709 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17710 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017711 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017712 such as other load-balancers.
17713
17714 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17715 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17716 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17717
17718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177198.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17720----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017721
17722The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17723what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17724or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017725"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017726just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17727log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17728after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17729is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17730with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17731with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17732
17733
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177348.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17735------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017736
17737Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17738for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17739"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17740retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17741raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17742a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17743file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17744you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17745"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17746
17747
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177488.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17749--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017750
17751Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17752multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17753them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17754"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17755logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17756error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17757and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17758too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17759useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17760alternative.
17761
17762
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177638.4. Timing events
17764------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017765
17766Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17767reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17768the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17769frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017770mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17771addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17772
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017773Timings events in HTTP mode:
17774
17775 first request 2nd request
17776 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17777 t tr t tr ...
17778 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17779 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17780 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17781 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17782 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17783
17784Timings events in TCP mode:
17785
17786 TCP session
17787 |<----------------->|
17788 t t
17789 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17790 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17791 |<------ Tt ------->|
17792
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017793 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017794 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017795 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17796 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17797 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017798 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017799 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17800 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17801 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17802 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017803
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017804 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17805 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17806 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017807 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17808 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17809 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17810 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17811 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17812 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017813
17814 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17815 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17816 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17817 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17818 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17819 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17820 request typed by hand during a test.
17821
17822 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17823 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017824 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017825 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17826 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17827 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17828 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017829
17830 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17831 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17832 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17833 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17834 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17835
17836 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17837 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17838 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17839 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17840 connection never established.
17841
17842 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17843 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17844 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17845 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17846 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17847 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17848 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17849 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17850 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17851 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17852 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17853
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017854 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17855 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17856 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17857 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17858 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17859 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17860
17861 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17862
17863 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17864 "Ta" can never be negative.
17865
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017866 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17867 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017868 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17869 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017870 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017871
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017872 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017873
17874 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017875 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17876 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017877
17878These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17879protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17880that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017881due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17882"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17883that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017884
17885Most common cases :
17886
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017887 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17888 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17889 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17890 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17891 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17892 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17893 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17894 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17895 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17896 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17897 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017898 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017899
17900 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17901 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17902 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17903 of ms on remote networks.
17904
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017905 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17906 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17907 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017908
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017909 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17910 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17911 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17912 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17913 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17914 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17915 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17916 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17917 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017918
17919Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17920
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017921 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017922 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017923 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017924
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017925 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017926 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17927 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17928
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017929 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017930 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17931 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17932 flags.
17933
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017934 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17935 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017936 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17937 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17938 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17939 the client connection was maintained open.
17940
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017941 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017942 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017943 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017944 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17945
17946
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179478.5. Session state at disconnection
17948-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017949
17950TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17951"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
179522-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17953each of which has a special meaning :
17954
17955 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17956 session to terminate :
17957
17958 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17959
17960 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17961 server explicitly refused it.
17962
17963 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17964 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17965 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17966 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017967 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017968
17969 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17970 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017971
17972 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17973 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17974 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17975 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17976 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17977
17978 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17979 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17980 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17981 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17982 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17983
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017984 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17985 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17986
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017987 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17988 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17989 backup connections when going up.
17990
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017991 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17992
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017993 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17994 send or receive data.
17995
17996 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17997 send or receive data.
17998
17999 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18000 with nothing left in the buffers.
18001
18002 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18003
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018004 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018005 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18006
18007 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18008 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18009 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18010 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18011 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18012
18013 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18014 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18015
18016 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18017 server (HTTP only).
18018
18019 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18020
18021 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18022 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18023 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18024
18025 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18026 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18027 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18028
18029 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18030
18031 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18032 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18033
18034 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18035 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18036 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18037
18038 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18039 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018040 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18041 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018042
18043 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18044 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18045 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18046 another server.
18047
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018048 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018049 server.
18050
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018051 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18052 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18053 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18054 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18055
18056 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18057 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18058 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18059 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18060
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018061 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18062 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18063 "use-server" rule).
18064
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018065 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18066
18067 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18068 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18069
18070 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18071
18072 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18073 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18074 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18075
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018076 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18077 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018078 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018079 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18080 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18081
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018082 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18083
18084 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18085 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18086
18087 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18088
18089 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18090
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018091The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18092was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018093helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18094starvation, attacks, etc...
18095
18096The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18097alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18098easier finding and understanding.
18099
18100 Flags Reason
18101
18102 -- Normal termination.
18103
18104 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18105 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18106 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18107 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18108
18109 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18110 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18111 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18112 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18113 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18114 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018115
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018116 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18117 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018118 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018119
18120 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18121 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18122 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18123
18124 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18125 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18126 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18127 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18128 the server takes too long to respond.
18129
18130 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18131 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18132 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18133 long a time to respond.
18134
18135 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18136 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18137 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18138 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018139 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18140 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018141
18142 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18143 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18144 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18145 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18146 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018147 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018148 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18149 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18150 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18151 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18152 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18153 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18154 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18155 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018156 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018157 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18158 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18159 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018160
18161 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18162 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018163 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18164 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18165 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18166 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018167
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018168 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18169 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18170
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018171 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018172 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18173 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018174 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018175 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18176 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18177
18178 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18179 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18180 503 or 504 here.
18181
18182 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18183 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18184 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18185 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18186 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18187
18188 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18189 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018190 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018191 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18192 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18193
18194 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18195 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18196 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18197 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18198 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18199 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18200 between haproxy and the server.
18201
18202 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18203 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18204 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18205 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18206 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18207 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18208 solution is to fix the application.
18209
18210 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18211 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18212 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18213 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18214 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18215 external attacks.
18216
18217 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18218 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018219 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018220 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18221 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18222
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018223 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18224 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18225 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018226 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018227 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018228
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018229 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18230 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18231 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18232 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018233 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18234 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18235 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18236 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18237 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018238
18239 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18240 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18241 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18242 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18243
18244 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18245 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18246 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18247 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18248
18249 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18250 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18251 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18252 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18253
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018254The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18255persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18256important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18257re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18258
18259 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18260
18261 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18262 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18263 set on a GET request.
18264
18265 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18266 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018267 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018268 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18269
18270 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18271 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18272 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18273
18274 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18275 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18276 already got a cookie.
18277
18278 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18279 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18280 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18281 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18282 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18283
18284 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18285 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18286 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18287
18288 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18289 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18290 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18291
18292 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18293 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18294
18295 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18296 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18297 then advertised in the response.
18298
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018299
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183008.6. Non-printable characters
18301-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018302
18303In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18304consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18305converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18306prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18307being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18308escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18309is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18310'}' when logging headers.
18311
18312Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18313issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18314containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18315
18316Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18317the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18318performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18319
18320
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183218.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18322---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018323
18324Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18325achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018326section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018327cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18328the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18329the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018330locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018331not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18332user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18333a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18334wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18335
18336 Examples :
18337 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18338 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18339
18340 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18341 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18342
18343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183448.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18345---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018346
18347Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18348proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18349the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18350server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18351
18352Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18353response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018354section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018355
18356It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018357time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18358appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018359are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18360and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18361follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18362request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18363in the logs.
18364
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018365As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18366frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18367an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18368
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018369 Example :
18370 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18371 listen proxy-out
18372 mode http
18373 option httplog
18374 option logasap
18375 log global
18376 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18377
18378 # log the name of the virtual server
18379 capture request header Host len 20
18380
18381 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18382 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18383
18384 # log the beginning of the referrer
18385 capture request header Referer len 20
18386
18387 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18388 capture response header Server len 20
18389
18390 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18391 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18392
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018393 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018394 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18395
18396 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18397 capture response header Via len 20
18398
18399 # log the URL location during a redirection
18400 capture response header Location len 20
18401
18402 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18403 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18404 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18405 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18406 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18407
18408 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18409 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18410 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18411 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018412 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018413
18414 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18415 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18416 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18417 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18418 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018419 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018420
18421
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184228.9. Examples of logs
18423---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018424
18425These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18426them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18427reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18428
18429 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18430 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18431 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18432
18433 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18434 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18435
18436 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18437 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18438 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18439
18440 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18441 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18442
18443 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18444 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18445 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18446
18447 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018448 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018449 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18450 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18451
18452 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18453 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18454 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18455
18456 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18457 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018458 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018459 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18460 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18461 to return the 502 and not the server.
18462
18463 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018464 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018465
18466 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18467 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18468 Nothing was sent to any server.
18469
18470 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18471 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18472
18473 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18474 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018475 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018476 send a 408 return code to the client.
18477
18478 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18479 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18480
18481 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18482 5 seconds ("c----").
18483
18484 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18485 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018486 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018487
18488 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018489 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018490 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18491 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18492 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18493 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18494 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018495
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018496
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200184979. Supported filters
18498--------------------
18499
18500Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18501accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18502unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18503
18504See also : "filter"
18505
185069.1. Trace
18507----------
18508
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018509filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018510
18511 Arguments:
18512 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18513 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18514
18515 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18516 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18517 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18518 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18519
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018520 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018521 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18522 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18523 amount of the parsed data.
18524
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018525 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018526
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018527This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18528callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18529information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18530filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18531
18532Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18533tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18534a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18535
18536
185379.2. HTTP compression
18538---------------------
18539
18540filter compression
18541
18542The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18543keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018544when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18545it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18546response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18547line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18548cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18549the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018550
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018551See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018552
18553
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200185549.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18555--------------------------------------------
18556
18557filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18558
18559 Arguments :
18560
18561 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18562 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18563 parsed.
18564
18565 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18566 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18567 part must be placed in its own scope.
18568
18569The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18570external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018571streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018572exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18573also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18574
18575SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18576the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18577
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018578For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018579"doc/SPOE.txt".
18580
18581Important note:
18582 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18583 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18584
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100185859.4. Cache
18586----------
18587
18588filter cache <name>
18589
18590 Arguments :
18591
18592 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18593
18594The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18595"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018596cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018597other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18598the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18599mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18600filter other than the compression is used for the same
18601listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18602order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018603
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018604See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018605
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001860610. Cache
18607---------
18608
18609HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18610(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18611RAM.
18612
18613The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018614this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018615
18616If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18617independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18618when we try to allocate a new one.
18619
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018620The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018621
18622It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18623"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18624for more details.
18625
18626When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18627replaced by "<CACHE>".
18628
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001862910.1. Limitation
18630----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018631
18632The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18633
18634- If the response is not a 200
18635- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018636- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018637- If the response is not cacheable
18638
18639- If the request is not a GET
18640- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018641- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018642
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018643Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18644filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18645can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18646example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18647"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018648
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001864910.2. Setup
18650-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018651
18652To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18653the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18654
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001865510.2.1. Cache section
18656---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018657
18658cache <name>
18659 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18660 size of cache is mandatory.
18661
18662total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018663 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018664 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018665
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018666max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018667 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18668 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18669 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018670
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018671max-age <seconds>
18672 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18673 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18674 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18675 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18676 default.
18677
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001867810.2.2. Proxy section
18679---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018680
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018681http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018682 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18683 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18684 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18685 after this one.
18686
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018687http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018688 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18689 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18690 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18691 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18692
18693
18694Example:
18695
18696 backend bck1
18697 mode http
18698
18699 http-request cache-use foobar
18700 http-response cache-store foobar
18701 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18702
18703 cache foobar
18704 total-max-size 4
18705 max-age 240
18706
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018707/*
18708 * Local variables:
18709 * fill-column: 79
18710 * End:
18711 */